[go: up one dir, main page]
More Web Proxy on the site http://driver.im/

US20090062308A1 - Methods of using sodium channel blockers - Google Patents

Methods of using sodium channel blockers Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20090062308A1
US20090062308A1 US12/190,022 US19002208A US2009062308A1 US 20090062308 A1 US20090062308 A1 US 20090062308A1 US 19002208 A US19002208 A US 19002208A US 2009062308 A1 US2009062308 A1 US 2009062308A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
chor
treating
compound
formula
effected
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US12/190,022
Inventor
Michael R. Johnson
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Parion Sciences Inc
Original Assignee
Parion Sciences Inc
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Family has litigation
First worldwide family litigation filed litigation Critical https://patents.darts-ip.com/?family=27752677&utm_source=google_patent&utm_medium=platform_link&utm_campaign=public_patent_search&patent=US20090062308(A1) "Global patent litigation dataset” by Darts-ip is licensed under a Creative Commons Attribution 4.0 International License.
Application filed by Parion Sciences Inc filed Critical Parion Sciences Inc
Priority to US12/190,022 priority Critical patent/US20090062308A1/en
Publication of US20090062308A1 publication Critical patent/US20090062308A1/en
Assigned to CFI, INC. reassignment CFI, INC. ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: JOHNSON, MICHAEL R.
Assigned to PARION SCIENCES, INC. reassignment PARION SCIENCES, INC. CHANGE OF NAME (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: CYFI, INC,
Assigned to CYFI, INC. reassignment CYFI, INC. CORRECTIVE TO CORRECT THE SPELLING OF ASSIGNEE'S NAME ON THE NOTICE OF RECORDATION PREVIOUSLY RECORDED ON REEL 023469 FRAME 0932. ASSIGNOR(S) HEREBY CONFIRMS THE CORRECT SPELLING OF THE ASSIGNEE'S NAME IS CYFI, INC. Assignors: JOHNSON, MICHAEL R.
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/4965Non-condensed pyrazines
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/4965Non-condensed pyrazines
    • A61K31/497Non-condensed pyrazines containing further heterocyclic rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/70Carbohydrates; Sugars; Derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/7042Compounds having saccharide radicals and heterocyclic rings
    • A61K31/7052Compounds having saccharide radicals and heterocyclic rings having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. nucleosides, nucleotides
    • A61K31/706Compounds having saccharide radicals and heterocyclic rings having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. nucleosides, nucleotides containing six-membered rings with nitrogen as a ring hetero atom
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K45/00Medicinal preparations containing active ingredients not provided for in groups A61K31/00 - A61K41/00
    • A61K45/06Mixtures of active ingredients without chemical characterisation, e.g. antiphlogistics and cardiaca
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/02Stomatological preparations, e.g. drugs for caries, aphtae, periodontitis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/04Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system for ulcers, gastritis or reflux esophagitis, e.g. antacids, inhibitors of acid secretion, mucosal protectants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/10Laxatives
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • A61P11/02Nasal agents, e.g. decongestants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • A61P11/06Antiasthmatics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • A61P11/08Bronchodilators
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • A61P11/10Expectorants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • A61P11/12Mucolytics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P13/00Drugs for disorders of the urinary system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P13/00Drugs for disorders of the urinary system
    • A61P13/02Drugs for disorders of the urinary system of urine or of the urinary tract, e.g. urine acidifiers
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P15/00Drugs for genital or sexual disorders; Contraceptives
    • A61P15/02Drugs for genital or sexual disorders; Contraceptives for disorders of the vagina
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P15/00Drugs for genital or sexual disorders; Contraceptives
    • A61P15/08Drugs for genital or sexual disorders; Contraceptives for gonadal disorders or for enhancing fertility, e.g. inducers of ovulation or of spermatogenesis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P17/00Drugs for dermatological disorders
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P17/00Drugs for dermatological disorders
    • A61P17/16Emollients or protectives, e.g. against radiation
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P27/00Drugs for disorders of the senses
    • A61P27/02Ophthalmic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P27/00Drugs for disorders of the senses
    • A61P27/16Otologicals
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P29/00Non-central analgesic, antipyretic or antiinflammatory agents, e.g. antirheumatic agents; Non-steroidal antiinflammatory drugs [NSAID]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P7/00Drugs for disorders of the blood or the extracellular fluid
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P7/00Drugs for disorders of the blood or the extracellular fluid
    • A61P7/10Antioedematous agents; Diuretics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • A61P9/12Antihypertensives
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D241/00Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings
    • C07D241/02Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings not condensed with other rings
    • C07D241/10Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings not condensed with other rings having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • C07D241/14Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings not condensed with other rings having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members with hetero atoms or with carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals, directly attached to ring carbon atoms
    • C07D241/24Carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals
    • C07D241/26Carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals with nitrogen atoms directly attached to ring carbon atoms
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D241/00Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings
    • C07D241/02Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings not condensed with other rings
    • C07D241/10Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings not condensed with other rings having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • C07D241/14Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings not condensed with other rings having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members with hetero atoms or with carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals, directly attached to ring carbon atoms
    • C07D241/24Carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals
    • C07D241/26Carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals with nitrogen atoms directly attached to ring carbon atoms
    • C07D241/28Carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals with nitrogen atoms directly attached to ring carbon atoms in which said hetero-bound carbon atoms have double bonds to oxygen, sulfur or nitrogen atoms
    • C07D241/30Carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals with nitrogen atoms directly attached to ring carbon atoms in which said hetero-bound carbon atoms have double bonds to oxygen, sulfur or nitrogen atoms in which said hetero-bound carbon atoms are part of a substructure —C(=X)—X—C(=X)—X— in which X is an oxygen or sulphur atom or an imino radical, e.g. imidoylguanidines
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D241/00Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings
    • C07D241/02Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings not condensed with other rings
    • C07D241/10Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings not condensed with other rings having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • C07D241/14Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings not condensed with other rings having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members with hetero atoms or with carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals, directly attached to ring carbon atoms
    • C07D241/24Carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals
    • C07D241/26Carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals with nitrogen atoms directly attached to ring carbon atoms
    • C07D241/28Carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals with nitrogen atoms directly attached to ring carbon atoms in which said hetero-bound carbon atoms have double bonds to oxygen, sulfur or nitrogen atoms
    • C07D241/30Carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals with nitrogen atoms directly attached to ring carbon atoms in which said hetero-bound carbon atoms have double bonds to oxygen, sulfur or nitrogen atoms in which said hetero-bound carbon atoms are part of a substructure —C(=X)—X—C(=X)—X— in which X is an oxygen or sulphur atom or an imino radical, e.g. imidoylguanidines
    • C07D241/32(Amino-pyrazinoyl) guanidines
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D405/00Heterocyclic compounds containing both one or more hetero rings having oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, and one or more rings having nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
    • C07D405/02Heterocyclic compounds containing both one or more hetero rings having oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, and one or more rings having nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom containing two hetero rings
    • C07D405/12Heterocyclic compounds containing both one or more hetero rings having oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, and one or more rings having nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom containing two hetero rings linked by a chain containing hetero atoms as chain links
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07HSUGARS; DERIVATIVES THEREOF; NUCLEOSIDES; NUCLEOTIDES; NUCLEIC ACIDS
    • C07H15/00Compounds containing hydrocarbon or substituted hydrocarbon radicals directly attached to hetero atoms of saccharide radicals
    • C07H15/26Acyclic or carbocyclic radicals, substituted by hetero rings

Definitions

  • the present invention relates to sodium channel blockers.
  • the present invention also includes a variety of methods of treatment using these inventive sodium channel blockers.
  • the mucosal surfaces at the interface between the environment and the body have evolved a number of “innate defense”, i.e., protective mechanisms.
  • a principal form of such innate defense is to cleanse these surfaces with liquid.
  • the quantity of the liquid layer on a mucosal surface reflects the balance between epithelial liquid secretion, often reflecting anion (Cl ⁇ and/or HCO 3 ⁇ ) secretion coupled with water (and a cation counter-ion), and epithelial liquid absorption, often reflecting Na + absorption, coupled with water and counter anion (Cl ⁇ and/or HCO 3 —).
  • ENaC epithelial Na + channel
  • the present invention describes diseases characterized by too little liquid on mucosal surfaces and “topical” sodium channel blockers designed to exhibit the increased potency, reduced mucosal absorption, and slow dissociation (“unbinding” or detachment) from ENaC required for therapy of these diseases.
  • Chronic bronchitis including the most common lethal genetic form of chronic bronchitis, cystic fibrosis (CF), are diseases that reflect the body's failure to clear mucus normally from the lungs, which ultimately produces chronic airways infection.
  • CB chronic bronchitis
  • CF cystic fibrosis
  • chronic bronchitis the primary defense against chronic intrapulmonary airways infection
  • This function in health effectively removes from the lung potentially noxious toxins and pathogens.
  • Recent data indicate that the initiating problem, i.e., the “basic defect,” in both CB and CF is the failure to clear mucus from airway surfaces.
  • ASL airway surface liquid
  • PCL peripheral liquid
  • the current afflicted population in the U.S. is 12,000,000 patients with the acquired (primarily from cigarette smoke exposure) form of chronic bronchitis and approximately 30,000 patients with the genetic form, cystic fibrosis. Approximately equal numbers of both populations are present in Europe. In Asia, there is little CF but the incidence of CB is high and, like the rest of the world, is increasing.
  • a major unmet therapeutic need for both CB and CF lung diseases is an effective means of re-hydrating airway mucus (i.e., restoring/expanding the volume of the ASL) and promoting its clearance, with bacteria, from the lung.
  • mucosal surfaces in and on the body exhibit subtle differences in the normal physiology of the protective surface liquids on their surfaces but the pathophysiology of disease reflects a common theme, i.e., too little protective surface liquid.
  • xerostomia dry mouth
  • the oral cavity is depleted of liquid due to a failure of the parotid sublingual and submandibular glands to secrete liquid despite continued Na + (ENaC) transport mediated liquid absorption from the oral cavity.
  • keratoconjunctivitis sira dry eye is caused by failure of lacrimal glands to secrete liquid in the face of continued Na + dependent liquid absorption on conjunctional surfaces.
  • novel sodium channel blockers of this invention can be designed to target the kidney and as such they may be used as diuretics for the treatment of hypertension, congestive heart failure (CHF) and other cardiovascular diseases.
  • CHF congestive heart failure
  • new agents may be used alone or in combination with beta-blockers, ACE inhibitors, HMGCoA reductase inhibitors, calcium channel blockers and other cardiovascular agents.
  • X is hydrogen, halogen, trifluoromethyl, lower alkyl, unsubstituted or substituted phenyl, lower alkyl-thio, phenyl-lower alkyl-thio, lower alkyl-sulfonyl, or phenyl-lower alkyl-sulfonyl;
  • Y is hydrogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, lower alkoxy, lower alkyl-thio, halogen, lower alkyl, unsubstituted or substituted mononuclear aryl, or —N(R 2 ) 2 ;
  • R 1 is hydrogen or lower alkyl
  • each R 2 is, independently, —R 7 , —(CH 2 ) m —OR 8 , —(CH 2 ) m —NR 7 R 10 , —(CH 2 ) n (CHOR 8 )(CHOR 8 ) n —CH 2 OR 8 , (CH 2 CH 2 O) m —R 8 , —(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —CH 2 CH 2 NR 7 R 10 , —(CH 2 ) n —C( ⁇ O)NR 7 R 10 , —(CH 2 ) n -Z g -R 7 , —(CH 2 ) m —NR 10 —CH 2 (CHOR 8 )(CHOR 8 ) n —CH 2 OR 8 , —(CH 2 ) n —CO 2 R 7 , or
  • R 3 and R 4 are each, independently, hydrogen, a group represented by formula (A), lower alkyl, hydroxy lower alkyl, phenyl, phenyl-lower alkyl, (halophenyl)-lower alkyl, lower-(alkylphenylalkyl), lower (alkoxyphenyl)-lower alkyl, naphthyl-lower alkyl, or pyridyl-lower alkyl, with the proviso that at least one of R 3 and R 4 is a group represented by formula (A):
  • each R 6 is, independently, —R 7 , —OR 11 , —N(R 7 ) 2 , —(CH 2 ) m —OR 8 , —O—(CH 2 ) m —OR 8 , —(CH 2 ) n —NR 7 R 10 , —O—(CH 2 ) m —NR 7 R 7 R 10 , —(CH 2 ) n (CHOR 8 )(CHOR 8 ) n —CH 2 OR 8 , —O—(CH 2 ) m (CHOR 8 )(CHOR 8 ) n —CH 2 OR 8 , —(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —R 8 , —O—(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —R 8 , —(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —CH 2 CH 2 NR 7 R 10 , —O—(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —CH 2 CH 2 NR 7 R 10 , —(CH
  • compositions which contain a compound described above.
  • the present invention also provides a method of promoting hydration of mucosal surfaces, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of restoring mucosal defense, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of blocking ENaC, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of promoting mucus clearance in mucosal surfaces, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating chronic bronchitis, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating cystic fibrosis, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating rhinosinusitis, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating nasal dehydration, comprising:
  • the nasal dehydration is brought on by administering dry oxygen to the subject.
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating sinusitis, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating pneumonia, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of preventing ventilator-induced pneumonia, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating asthma, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating primary ciliary dyskinesia, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating otitis media, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of inducing sputum for diagnostic purposes, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating chronic obstructive pulmonary disease, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating emphysema, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating dry eye, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of promoting ocular hydration, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of promoting corneal hydration, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating Sjögren's disease, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating vaginal dryness, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating dry skin, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating dry mouth (xerostomia), comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating distal intestinal obstruction syndrome, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating esophagitis, comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating constipation, comprising:
  • the compound is administered either orally or via a suppository or enema.
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating chronic diverticulitis comprising:
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating hypertension, comprising administering the compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • the present invention also provides a method of reducing blood pressure, comprising administering the compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • the present invention also provides a method of treating edema, comprising administering the compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • the present invention also provides a method of promoting diuresis, comprising administering the compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • the present invention also provides a method of promoting natriuresis, comprising administering the compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • the present invention also provides a method of promoting saluresis, comprising administering the compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • the present invention is based on the discovery that the compounds of formula (I) are more potent and/or, absorbed less rapidly from mucosal surfaces, especially airway surfaces, and/or less reversible from interactions with ENaC as compared to compounds such as amiloride, benzamil, and phenamil. Therefore, the compounds of formula (I) have a longer half-life on mucosal surfaces as compared to these compounds.
  • the present invention is also based on the discovery that certain compounds embraced by formula (I) are converted in vivo into metabolic derivatives thereof that have reduced efficacy in blocking sodium channels as compared to the parent administered compound, after they are absorbed from mucosal surfaces after administration. This important property means that the compounds will have a lower tendency to cause undesired side-effects by blocking sodium channels located at untargeted locations in the body of the recipient, e.g., in the kidneys.
  • the present invention is also based on the discovery that certain compounds embraced by formula (I) target the kidney and thus may be used as cardiovascular agents.
  • X may be hydrogen, halogen, trifluoromethyl, lower alkyl, lower cycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted phenyl, lower alkyl-thio, phenyl-lower alkyl-thio, lower alkyl-sulfonyl, or phenyl-lower alkyl-sulfonyl. Halogen is preferred.
  • halogen examples include fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine. Chlorine and bromine are the preferred halogens. Chlorine is particularly preferred. This description is applicable to the term “halogen” as used throughout the present disclosure.
  • lower alkyl means an alkyl group having less than 8 carbon atoms. This range includes all specific values of carbon atoms and subranges there between, such as 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, and 7 carbon atoms.
  • alkyl embraces all types of such groups, e.g., linear, branched, and cyclic alkyl groups. This description is applicable to the term “lower alkyl” as used throughout the present disclosure. Examples of suitable lower alkyl groups include methyl, ethyl, propyl, cyclopropyl, butyl, isobutyl, etc.
  • Substituents for the phenyl group include halogens. Particularly preferred halogen substituents are chlorine and bromine.
  • Y may be hydrogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, lower alkoxy, lower alkyl-thio, halogen, lower alkyl, lower cycloalkyl, mononuclear aryl, or —N(R 2 ) 2 .
  • the alkyl moiety of the lower alkoxy groups is the same as described above.
  • mononuclear aryl include phenyl groups.
  • the phenyl group may be unsubstituted or substituted as described above.
  • the preferred identity of Y is —N(R 2 ) 2 . Particularly preferred are such compounds where each R 2 is hydrogen.
  • R 1 may be hydrogen or lower alkyl. Hydrogen is preferred for R 1 .
  • Each R 2 may be, independently, —R 7 , —(CH 2 ) m —OR 8 , —(CH 2 ) m —NR 7 R 10 , —(CH 2 ) n (CHOR 8 )(CHOR 8 ) n —CH 2 OR 8 , —(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —R 8 , —(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —CH 2 CH 2 NR 7 R 10 , —(CH 2 ) n —C( ⁇ O)NR 7 R 10 , —(CH 2 ) n -Z g -R 7 , —(CH 2 ) m —NR 10 —CH 2 (CHOR 8 )(CHOR 8 ) n —CH 2 OR 8 , —(CH 2 ) n —CO 2 R 7 , or
  • Hydrogen and lower alkyl, particularly C 1 -C 3 alkyl are preferred for R 2 . Hydrogen is particularly preferred.
  • R 3 and R 4 may be, independently, hydrogen, a group represented by formula (A), lower alkyl, hydroxy lower alkyl, phenyl, phenyl-lower alkyl, (halophenyl)-lower alkyl, lower-(alkylphenylalkyl), lower (alkoxyphenyl)-lower alkyl, naphthyl-lower alkyl, or pyridyl-lower alkyl, provided that at least one of R 3 and R 4 is a group represented by formula (A).
  • Preferred compounds are those where one of R 3 and R 4 is hydrogen and the other is represented by formula (A).
  • the moiety —(C(R L ) 2 ) o -x-(C(R L ) 2 ) p — defines an alkylene group bonded to the aromatic ring.
  • the variables o and p may each be an integer from 0 to 10, subject to the proviso that the sum of o and p in the chain is from 1 to 10.
  • o and p may each be 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10.
  • the sum of o and p is from 2 to 6. In a particularly preferred embodiment, the sum of o and p is 4.
  • the linking group in the alkylene chain, x may be, independently, O, NR 10 , C( ⁇ O), CHOH, C( ⁇ N—R 10 ), CHNR 7 R 10 , or represents a single bond;
  • the alkylene chain bonded to the ring is represented by the formula —(C(R L ) 2 ) o+p —, in which the sum o+p is from 1 to 10.
  • Each R L may be, independently, —R 7 , —(CH 2 ) n —OR 8 , —O—(CH 2 ) m —OR 8 , —(CH 2 ) n —NR 7 R 10 , —O—(CH 2 ) m —NR 7 R 10 , —(CH 2 ) n (CHOR 8 )(CHOR 8 ) n —CH 2 OR 8 , —O—(CH 2 ) m (CHOR 8 ) m (CHOR 8 ) n —CH 2 OR 8 , —(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —R 8 , —O—(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —R 8 , —(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —CH 2 CH 2 NR 7 R 10 , —O—(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —CH 2 CH 2 NR 7 R 10 , —O—(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —CH 2 CH 2
  • the preferred R L groups include —H, —OH, —N(R 7 ) 2 , especially where each R 7 is hydrogen.
  • the alkylene chain in formula (A) it is preferred that when one R L group bonded to a carbon atoms is other than hydrogen, then the other R L bonded to that carbon atom is hydrogen, i.e., the formula —CHR L —. It is also preferred that at most two R L groups in an alkylene chain are other than hydrogen, where in the other R L groups in the chain are hydrogens. Even more preferably, only one R L group in an alkylene chain is other than hydrogen, where in the other R L groups in the chain are hydrogens. In these embodiments, it is preferable that x represents a single bond.
  • all of the R L groups in the alkylene chain are hydrogen.
  • the alkylene chain is represented by the formula
  • Each R 5 may be, independently, —(CH 2 ) m —OR 8 , —O—(CH 2 ) m —OR 8 , —(CH 2 ) n —NR 7 R 10 , —O—(CH 2 ) m —NR 7 R 10 , —(CH 2 ) n (CHOR 8 )(CHOR 8 ) n —CH 2 OR 8 , —O—(CH 2 ) m (CHOR 8 )(CHOR 8 ) n —CH 2 OR 8 , —(CH 2 CH 2 ) m —R 8 , —O—(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —R 8 , —(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —CH 2 CH 2 NR 7 R 10 , —O—(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —CH 2 CH 2 NR 7 R 10 , —O—(CH 2 CH 2 O) m —CH 2 CH 2 NR 7 R 10 , —
  • R 5 may be one of the following:
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of —O—(CH 2 ) 3 —OH, —NH 2 , —O—CH 2 —(CHOH) 2 —CH 2 OH, —O—CH 2 —CHOH—CH 2 OH, —O—CH 2 CH 2 —O-tetrahydropyran-2-yl, —O—CH 2 CHOH—CH 2 —O-glucuronide, —O—CH 2 CH 2 OH, —O—(CH 2 CH 2 O) 4 —CH 3 , —O—CH 2 CH 2 OCH 3 , —O—CH 2 —(CHOC( ⁇ O)CH 3 )—CH 2 —OC( ⁇ O)CH 3 , —O—(CH 2 CH 2 O) 2 —CH 3 , —OCH 2 —CHOH—CHOH—CH 2 OH, —CH 2 OH, —CO 2 CH 3 ,
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of para —O—(CH 2 ) 3 —OH, para —NH 2 , para —O—CH 2 —(CHOH) 2 —CH 2 OH, ortho —O—CH 2 —CHOH—CH 2 OH, meta —O—CH 2 —CHOH—CH 2 OH, para —O—CH 2 CH 2 —O-tetrahydropyran-2-yl, para —O—CH 2 CHOH—CH 2 —O-glucuronide, para —O—CH 2 CH 2 OH, para —O—(CH 2 CH 2 O) 4 —CH 3 , para —O—CH 2 CH 2 OCH 3 , para —O—CH 2 —(CHOC( ⁇ O)CH 3 )—CH 2 —OC( ⁇ O)CH 3 , para —O—(CH 2 CH 2 O) 2 —CH 3 , —OCH 2 —CHOH—CHOH—CH 2 OH, para —NH 2
  • each —(CH 2 ) n -(Z) g -R 7 falls within the scope of the structures described above and is, independently,
  • each —O—(CH 2 ) m -(Z) g -R 7 falls within the scope of the structures described above and is, independently,
  • R 5 may be one of the following: —O—CH 2 CHOHCH 2 O-glucuronide,
  • Each R 6 may be each, independently, —R 7 , —OR 11 , —N(R 7 ) 2 , —(CH 2 ) n —OR 8 ,
  • one of more of the R 6 groups can be one of the R 5 groups which fall within the broad definition of R 6 set forth above.
  • the alkyl moieties of the two R 6 groups may be bonded together to form a methylenedioxy group, i.e., a group of the formula —O—CH 2 —O—.
  • R 6 may be hydrogen. Therefore, 1, 2, 3, or 4 R 6 groups may be other than hydrogen. Preferably at most 3 of the R 6 groups are other than hydrogen.
  • each g is, independently, an integer from 1 to 6. Therefore, each g may be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6.
  • each m is an integer from 1 to 7. Therefore, each m may be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.
  • each n is an integer from 0 to 7. Therefore, each n may be 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.
  • Each Q in formula (A) is C—R 5 , C—R 6 , or a nitrogen atom, where at most three Q in a ring are nitrogen atoms. Thus, there may be 1, 2, or 3 nitrogen atoms in a ring. Preferably, at most two Q are nitrogen atoms. More preferably, at most one Q is a nitrogen atom. In one particular embodiment, the nitrogen atom is at the 3-position of the ring. In another embodiment of the invention, each Q is either C—R 5 or C—R 6 , i.e., there are no nitrogen atoms in the ring.
  • n is an integer from 1 to 10 and R 5 is as defined above;
  • n is an integer from 1 from 10 and R 5 is as defined above;
  • Y is —NH 2 .
  • R 2 is hydrogen
  • R 1 is hydrogen
  • X is chlorine
  • R 3 is hydrogen
  • R L is hydrogen
  • o is 4.
  • p is 0.
  • the sum of o and p is 4.
  • x represents a single bond.
  • R 6 is hydrogen
  • At most one Q is a nitrogen atom.
  • no Q is a nitrogen atom.
  • X is halogen
  • Y is —N(R 7 ) 2 ;
  • R 1 is hydrogen or C 1 -C 3 alkyl
  • R 2 is —R 7 , —OR 7 , CH 2 OR 7 , or —CO 2 R 7 ;
  • R 3 is a group represented by formula (A).
  • R 4 is hydrogen, a group represented by formula (A), or lower alkyl
  • X is chloro or bromo
  • Y is —N(R 7 ) 2 ;
  • R is hydrogen or C 1 -C 3 alkyl
  • R 6 are other than hydrogen as described above;
  • Y is —NH 2 ;
  • R 4 is hydrogen
  • At most one L is other than hydrogen as described above;
  • the compounds of formula (I) may be prepared and used as the free base. Alternatively, the compounds may be prepared and used as a pharmaceutically acceptable salt.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable salts are salts that retain or enhance the desired biological activity of the parent compound and do not impart undesired toxicological effects.
  • salts are (a) acid addition salts formed with inorganic acids, for example, hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, phosphoric acid, nitric acid and the like; (b) salts formed with organic acids such as, for example, acetic acid, oxalic acid, tartaric acid, succinic acid, maleic acid, fumaric acid, gluconic acid, citric acid, malic acid, ascorbic acid, benzoic acid, tannic acid, palmitic acid, alginic acid, polyglutamic acid, naphthalenesulfonic acid, methanesulfonic acid, p-toluenesulfonic acid, naphthalenedisulfonic acid, polygalacturonic acid, malonic acid, sulfosalicylic acid, glycolic acid, 2-hydroxy-3-naphthoate, pamoate, salicylic acid, stearic acid, phthalic acid, mandelic acid,
  • the compounds of formula (I) function in vivo as sodium channel blockers.
  • the compounds of formula (I) reduce the absorption of water by the mucosal surfaces. This effect increases the volume of protective liquids on mucosal surfaces, rebalances the system, and thus treats disease.
  • the present invention also provides methods of treatment that take advantage of the properties of the compounds of formula (I) discussed above.
  • subjects that may be treated by the methods of the present invention include, but are not limited to, patients afflicted with cystic fibrosis, primary ciliary dyskinesia, chronic bronchitis, chronic obstructive airway disease, artificially ventilated patients, patients with acute pneumonia, etc.
  • the present invention may be used to obtain a sputum sample from a patient by administering the active compounds to at least one lung of a patient, and then inducing or collecting a sputum sample from that patient.
  • the invention will be administered to respiratory mucosal surfaces via aerosol (liquid or dry powders) or lavage.
  • Subjects that may be treated by the method of the present invention also include patients being administered supplemental oxygen nasally (a regimen that tends to dry the airway surfaces); patients afflicted with an allergic disease or response (e.g., an allergic response to pollen, dust, animal hair or particles, insects or insect particles, etc.) that affects nasal airway surfaces; patients afflicted with a bacterial infection e.g., staphylococcus infections such as Staphylococcus aureus infections, Hemophilus influenza infections, Streptococcus pneumoniae infections, Pseudomonas aeuriginosa infections, etc.) of the nasal airway surfaces; patients afflicted with an inflammatory disease that affects nasal airway surfaces; or patients afflicted with sinusitis (wherein the active agent or agents are administered to promote drainage of congested mucous secretions in the sinuses by administering an amount effective to promote drainage of congested fluid in the sinuses), or combined, Rhinosinusitis.
  • the invention may be
  • the present invention may be used to hydrate mucosal surfaces other than airway surfaces.
  • mucosal surfaces include gastrointestinal surfaces, oral surfaces, genito-urethral surfaces, ocular surfaces or surfaces of the eye, the inner ear and the middle ear.
  • the active compounds of the present invention may be administered by any suitable means, including locally/topically, orally, or rectally, in an effective amount.
  • the compounds of the present invention are also useful for treating a variety of functions relating to the cardiovascular system.
  • the compounds of the present invention are useful for use as antihypertensive agents.
  • the compounds may also be used to reduce blood pressure and to treat edema.
  • the compounds of the present invention are also useful for promoting diuresis, natriuresis, and saluresis.
  • the compounds may be used alone or in combination with beta blockers, ACE inhibitors, HMGCoA reductase inhibitors, calcium channel blockers and other cardiovascular agents to treat hypertension, congestive heart failure and reduce cardiovascular mortality.
  • the present invention is concerned primarily with the treatment of human subjects, but may also be employed for the treatment of other mammalian subjects, such as dogs and cats, for veterinary purposes.
  • the compounds used to prepare the compositions of the present invention may be in the form of a pharmaceutically acceptable free base. Because the free base of the compound is generally less soluble in aqueous solutions than the salt, free base compositions are employed to provide more sustained release of active agent to the lungs. An active agent present in the lungs in particulate form which has not dissolved into solution is not available to induce a physiological response, but serves as a depot of bioavailable drug which gradually dissolves into solution.
  • compositions comprising a compound of formula (I) in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier (e.g., an aqueous carrier solution).
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier e.g., an aqueous carrier solution.
  • the compound of formula (I) is included in the composition in an amount effective to inhibit the reabsorption of water by mucosal surfaces.
  • the compounds of the present invention may also be used in conjunction with a P2Y2 receptor agonist or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof (also sometimes referred to as an “active agent” herein).
  • the composition may further comprise a P2Y2 receptor agonist or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof (also sometimes referred to as an “active agent” herein).
  • the P2Y2 receptor agonist is typically included in an amount effective to stimulate chloride and water secretion by airway surfaces, particularly nasal airway surfaces. Suitable P2Y2 receptor agonists are described in columns 9-10 of U.S. Pat. No. 6,264,975, U.S. Pat. No. 5,656,256, and U.S. Pat. No. 5,292,498, each of which is incorporated herein by reference.
  • Bronchodiloators can also be used in combination with compounds of the present invention.
  • These bronchodilators include, but are not limited to, ⁇ -adrenergic agonists including but not limited to epinephrine, isoproterenol, fenoterol, albutereol, terbutalin, pirbuterol, bitolterol, metaproterenol, iosetharine, salmeterol xinafoate, as well as anticholinergic agents including but not limited to ipratropium bromide, as well as compounds such as theophylline and aminophylline.
  • ⁇ -adrenergic agonists including but not limited to epinephrine, isoproterenol, fenoterol, albutereol, terbutalin, pirbuterol, bitolterol, metaproterenol, iosetharine, salmeterol xinafo
  • Another aspect of the present invention is a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising an active compound as described above in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier (e.g., an aqueous carrier solution).
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier e.g., an aqueous carrier solution.
  • the active compound is included in the composition in an amount effective to treat mucosal surfaces, such as inhibiting the reabsorption of water by mucosal surfaces, including airway and other surfaces.
  • the active compounds disclosed herein may be administered to mucosal surfaces by any suitable means, including topically, orally, rectally, vaginally, ocularly and dermally, etc.
  • the active compounds may be administered orally or rectally to the gastrointestinal mucosal surface.
  • the active compound may be combined with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier in any suitable form, such as sterile physiological or dilute saline or topical solution, as a droplet, tablet or the like for oral administration, as a suppository for rectal or genito-urethral administration, etc.
  • Excipients may be included in the formulation to enhance the solubility of the active compounds, as desired.
  • the active compounds disclosed herein may be administered to the airway surfaces of a patient by any suitable means, including as a spray, mist, or droplets of the active compounds in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier such as physiological or dilute saline solutions or distilled water.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier such as physiological or dilute saline solutions or distilled water.
  • the active compounds may be prepared as formulations and administered as described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,789,391 to Jacobus, the disclosure of which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety.
  • Solid or liquid particulate active agents prepared for practicing the present invention could, as noted above, include particles of respirable or non-respirable size; that is, for respirable particles, particles of a size sufficiently small to pass through the mouth and larynx upon inhalation and into the bronchi and alveoli of the lungs, and for non-respirable particles, particles sufficiently large to be retained in the nasal airway passages rather than pass through the larynx and into the bronchi and alveoli of the lungs.
  • particles ranging from about 1 to 5 microns in size (more particularly, less than about 4.7 microns in size) are respirable.
  • Particles of non-respirable size are greater than about 5 microns in size, up to the size of visible droplets.
  • a particle size in the range of 10-500 ⁇ m may be used to ensure retention in the nasal cavity.
  • active agents or the physiologically acceptable salts or free bases thereof are typically admixed with, inter alia, an acceptable carrier.
  • the carrier must be compatible with any other ingredients in the formulation and must not be deleterious to the patient.
  • the carrier must be solid or liquid, or both, and is preferably formulated with the compound as a unit-dose formulation, for example, a capsule, that may contain 0.5% to 99% by weight of the active compound.
  • One or more active compounds may be incorporated in the formulations of the invention, which formulations may be prepared by any of the well-known techniques of pharmacy consisting essentially of admixing the components.
  • compositions containing respirable or non-respirable dry particles of micronized active agent may be prepared by grinding the dry active agent with a mortar and pestle, and then passing the micronized composition through a 400 mesh screen to break up or separate out large agglomerates.
  • the particulate active agent composition may optionally contain a dispersant which serves to facilitate the formulation of an aerosol.
  • a suitable dispersant is lactose, which may be blended with the active agent in any suitable ratio (e.g., a 1 to 1 ratio by weight).
  • Active compounds disclosed herein may be administered to airway surfaces including the nasal passages, sinuses and lungs of a subject by a suitable means know in the art, such as by nose drops, mists, etc.
  • the active compounds of the present invention and administered by transbronchoscopic lavage are deposited on lung airway surfaces by administering an aerosol suspension of respirable particles comprised of the active compound, which the subject inhales.
  • the respirable particles may be liquid or solid. Numerous inhalers for administering aerosol particles to the lungs of a subject are known.
  • Inhalers such as those developed by Inhale Therapeutic Systems, Palo Alto, Calif., USA, may be employed, including but not limited to those disclosed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,740,794; 5,654,007; 5,458,135; 5,775,320; and 5,785,049, each of which is incorporated herein by reference.
  • the Applicant specifically intends that the disclosures of all patent references cited herein be incorporated by reference herein in their entirety.
  • Inhalers such as those developed by Dura Pharmaceuticals, Inc., San Diego, Calif., USA, may also be employed, including but not limited to those disclosed in U.S. Pat. Nos.
  • Aerosols of liquid particles comprising the active compound may be produced by any suitable means, such as with a pressure-driven aerosol nebulizer or an ultrasonic nebulizer. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,501,729, which is incorporated herein by reference.
  • Nebulizers are commercially available devices which transform solutions or suspensions of the active ingredient into a therapeutic aerosol mist either by means of acceleration of compressed gas, typically air or oxygen, through a narrow venturi orifice or by means of ultrasonic agitation.
  • Suitable formulations for use in nebulizers consist of the active ingredient in a liquid carrier, the active ingredient comprising up to 40% w/w of the formulation, but preferably less than 20% w/w.
  • the carrier is typically water (and most preferably sterile, pyrogen-free water) or dilute aqueous alcoholic solution. Perfluorocarbon carriers may also be used.
  • Optional additives include preservatives if the formulation is not made sterile, for example, methyl hydroxybenzoate, antioxidants, flavoring agents, volatile oils, buffering agents and surfactants.
  • Aerosols of solid particles comprising the active compound may likewise be produced with any solid particulate medicament aerosol generator.
  • Aerosol generators for administering solid particulate medicaments to a subject produce particles which are respirable, as explained above, and generate a volume of aerosol containing predetermined metered dose of medicament at a rate suitable for human administration.
  • One illustrative type of solid particulate aerosol generator is an insufflator.
  • Suitable formulations for administration by insufflation include finely comminuted powders which may be delivered by means of an insufflator or taken into the nasal cavity in the manner of a snuff.
  • the powder e.g., a metered dose thereof effective to carry out the treatments described herein
  • the powder is contained in capsules or cartridges, typically made of gelatin or plastic, which are either pierced or opened in situ and the powder delivered by air drawn through the device upon inhalation or by means of a manually-operated pump.
  • the powder employed in the insufflator consists either solely of the active ingredient or of powder blend comprising the active ingredient, a suitable powder diluent, such as lactose, and an optional surfactant.
  • the active ingredient typically comprises of 0.1 to 100% w/w of the formulation.
  • a second type of illustrative aerosol generator comprises a metered dose inhaler.
  • Metered dose inhalers are pressurized aerosol dispensers, typically containing a suspension or solution formulation of active ingredient in a liquified propellant. During use, these devices discharge the formulation through a valve adapted to deliver a metered volume, typically from 10 to 150 ⁇ l, to produce a fine particle spray containing the active ingredient.
  • Suitable propellants include certain chlorofluorocarbon compounds, for example, dichlorodifluoromethane, trichlorofluoromethane, dichlorotetrafluoroethane and mixtures thereof.
  • the formulation may additionally contain one of more co-solvents, for example, ethanol, surfactants, such as oleic acid or sorbitan trioleate, antioxidants and suitable flavoring agents.
  • the aerosol may be produced by the aerosol generator at a rate of from about 10 to 150 liters per minute, more preferable from 30 to 150 liters per minute, and most preferably about 60 liters per minute. Aerosols containing greater amounts of medicament may be administered more rapidly.
  • the dosage of the active compounds disclosed herein will vary depending on the condition being treated and the state of the subject, but generally may be from about 0.01, 0.03, 0.05, 0.1 to 1, 5, 10 or 20 mg of the pharmaceutic agent, deposited on the airway surfaces.
  • the daily dose may be divided among one or multiple unit dose administrations.
  • the goal is to achieve a concentration of the pharmaceutic agents on lung airway surfaces of between 10 ⁇ 9 -10 4 M.
  • respirable or non-respirable particles preferably non-respirable particles
  • active compound preferably non-respirable particles
  • the respirable or non-respirable particles may be liquid or solid.
  • the quantity of active agent included may be an amount of sufficient to achieve dissolved concentrations of active agent on the airway surfaces of the subject of from about 10 ⁇ 9 , 10 ⁇ 8 , or 10 ⁇ 7 to about 10 ⁇ 3 , 10 ⁇ 2 , 10 ⁇ 1 moles/liter, and more preferably from about 10 ⁇ 9 to about 10 ⁇ 4 moles/liter.
  • the dosage of active compound will vary depending on the condition being treated and the state of the subject, but generally may be an amount sufficient to achieve dissolved concentrations of active compound on the nasal airway surfaces of the subject from about 10 ⁇ 9 , 10 ⁇ 8 , 10 ⁇ 7 to about 10 ⁇ 3 , 10 ⁇ 2 , or 10 ⁇ 1 moles/liter, and more preferably from about 10 ⁇ 7 to about 10 ⁇ 4 moles/liter.
  • the daily dose may be divided among one or several unit dose administrations.
  • the daily dose by weight may range from about 0.01, 0.03, 0.1, 0.5 or 1.0 to 10 or 20 milligrams of active agent particles for a human subject, depending upon the age and condition of the subject.
  • a currently preferred unit dose is about 0.5 milligrams of active agent given at a regimen of 2-10 administrations per day.
  • the dosage may be provided as a prepackaged unit by any suitable means (e.g., encapsulating a gelatin capsule).
  • the particulate active agent composition may contain both a free base of active agent and a pharmaceutically acceptable salt to provide both early release and sustained release of active agent for dissolution into the mucus secretions of the nose.
  • a composition serves to provide both early relief to the patient, and sustained relief over time. Sustained relief, by decreasing the number of daily administrations required, is expected to increase patient compliance with the course of active agent treatments.
  • compositions suitable for airway administration include formulations of solutions, emulsions, suspensions and extracts. See generally, J. Nairn, Solutions, Emulsions, Suspensions and Extracts, in Remington: The Science and Practice of Pharmacy, chap. 86 (19 th ed. 1995), incorporated herein by reference.
  • Pharmaceutical formulations suitable for nasal administration may be prepared as described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,389,393 to Schor; 5,707,644 to Illum; 4,294,829 to Suzuki; and 4,835,142 to Suzuki, the disclosures of which are incorporated by reference herein in their entirety.
  • Mists or aerosols of liquid particles comprising the active compound may be produced by any suitable means, such as by a simple nasal spray with the active agent in an aqueous pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, such as a sterile saline solution or sterile water. Administration may be with a pressure-driven aerosol nebulizer or an ultrasonic nebulizer. See e.g. U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,501,729 and 5,656,256, both of which are incorporated herein by reference.
  • Suitable formulations for use in a nasal droplet or spray bottle or in nebulizers consist of the active ingredient in a liquid carrier, the active ingredient comprising up to 40% w/w of the formulation, but preferably less than 20% w/w.
  • the carrier is water (and most preferably sterile, pyrogen-free water) or dilute aqueous alcoholic solution, preferably made in a 0.12% to 0.8% solution of sodium chloride.
  • Optional additives include preservatives if the formulation is not made sterile, for example, methyl hydroxybenzoate, antioxidants, flavoring agents, volatile oils, buffering agents, osmotically active agents (e.g. mannitol, xylitol, erythritol) and surfactants.
  • compositions containing respirable or non-respirable dry particles of micronized active agent may be prepared by grinding the dry active agent with a mortar and pestle, and then passing the micronized composition through a 400 mesh screen to break up or separate out large agglomerates.
  • the particulate composition may optionally contain a dispersant which serves to facilitate the formation of an aerosol.
  • a suitable dispersant is lactose, which may be blended with the active agent in any suitable ratio (e.g., a 1 to 1 ratio by weight).
  • the compounds of formula (I) may be synthesized according to procedures known in the art. A representative synthetic procedure is shown in the scheme below:
  • One assay used to assess mechanism of action and/or potency of the compounds of the present invention involves the determination of lumenal drug inhibition of airway epithelial sodium currents measured under short circuit current (I SC ) using airway epithelial monolayers mounted in Using chambers.
  • I SC short circuit current
  • Cells obtained from freshly excised human, dog, sheep or rodent airways are seeded onto porous 0.4 micron SnapwellTM Inserts (CoStar), cultured at air-liquid interface (ALI) conditions in hormonally defined media, and assayed for sodium transport activity (I SC ) while bathed in Krebs Bicarbonate Ringer (KBR) in Using chambers.
  • All test drug additions are to the lumenal bath with half-log dose addition protocols (from 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 11 M to 3 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 5 M), and the cumulative change in I SC (inhibition) recorded.
  • All drugs are prepared in dimethyl sulfoxide as stock solutions at a concentration of 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 2 M and stored at ⁇ 20° C. Eight preparations are typically run in parallel; two preparations per run incorporate amiloride and/or benzamil as positive controls. After the maximal concentration (5 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 5 M) is administered, the lumenal bath is exchanged three times with fresh drug-free KBR solution, and the resultant I SC measured after each wash for approximately 5 minutes in duration. Reversibility is defined as the percent return to the baseline value for sodium current after the third wash. All data from the voltage clamps are collected via a computer interface and analyzed off-line.
  • IC 50 values, maximal effective concentrations, and reversibility are calculated and compared to amiloride and benzamil as positive controls.
  • Bronchial cells (dog, human, sheep, or rodent cells) are seeded at a density of 0.25 ⁇ 10 6 /cm 2 on a porous Transwell-Col collagen-coated membrane with a growth area of 1.13 cm 2 grown at an air-liquid interface in hormonally defined media that promotes a polarized epithelium. From 12 to 20 days after development of an air-liquid interface (ALI) the cultures are expected to be >90% ciliated, and mucins will accumulate on the cells. To ensure the integrity of primary airway epithelial cell preparations, the transepithelial resistance (R t ) and transepithelial potential differences (PD), which are indicators of the integrity of polarized nature of the culture, are measured.
  • R t transepithelial resistance
  • PD transepithelial potential differences
  • the disappearance assay is conducted under conditions that mimic the “thin” films in vivo ( ⁇ 25 ⁇ l) and is initiated by adding experimental sodium channel blockers or positive controls (amiloride, benzamil, phenamil) to the apical surface at an initial concentration of 10 ⁇ M.
  • a series of samples (5 ⁇ l volume per sample) is collected at various time points, including 0, 5, 20, 40, 90 and 240 minutes. Concentrations are determined by measuring intrinsic fluorescence of each sodium channel blocker using a Fluorocount Microplate Fluorometer or HPLC. Quantitative analysis employs a standard curve generated from authentic reference standard materials of known concentration and purity. Data analysis of the rate of disappearance is performed using nonlinear regression, one phase exponential decay (Prism V 3.0).
  • Airway epithelial cells have the capacity to metabolize drugs during the process of transepithelial absorption. Further, although less likely, it is possible that drugs can be metabolized on airway epithelial surfaces by specific ectoenzyme activities. Perhaps more likely as an ecto-surface event, compounds may be metabolized by the infected secretions that occupy the airway lumens of patients with lung disease, e.g. cystic fibrosis. Thus, a series of assays is performed to characterize the compound metabolism that results from the interaction of test compounds with human airway epithelia and/or human airway epithelial lumenal products.
  • test compounds in KBR as an “ASL” stimulant are applied to the apical surface of human airway epithelial cells grown in the T-Col insert system.
  • metabolism generation of new species
  • HPLC high performance liquid chromatography
  • a test solution 25 ⁇ l KBR, containing 10 ⁇ M test compound is placed on the epithelial lumenal surface.
  • Sequential 5 to 10 ⁇ l samples are obtained from the lumenal and serosal compartments for HPLC analysis of (1) the mass of test compound permeating from the lumenal to serosal bath and (2) the potential formation of metabolites from the parent compound.
  • radiolabeled compounds are used for these assays.
  • the rate of disappearance and/or formation of novel metabolite compounds on the lumenal surface and the appearance of test compound and/or novel metabolite in the basolateral solution is quantitated.
  • the data relating the chromatographic mobility of potential novel metabolites with reference to the parent compound are also quantitated.
  • Typical studies of compound metabolism by CF sputum involve the addition of known masses of test compound to “neat” CF sputum and aliquots of CF sputum “supernatant” incubated at 37° C., followed by sequential sampling of aliquots from each sputum type for characterization of compound stability/metabolism by HPLC analysis as described above. As above, analysis of compound disappearance, rates of formation of novel metabolities, and HPLC mobilities of novel metabolites are then performed.
  • MCC mucociliary clearance
  • GC-analysis was performed on a Shimadzu GC-17 equipped with a Heliflex Capillary Column (Alltech); Phase: AT-1, Length: 10 meters, ID: 0.53 mm, Film: 0.25 micrometers.
  • GC Parameters Injector at 320° C., Detector at 320° C., FID gas flow: H 2 at 40 ml/min., Air at 400 ml/min.
  • Carrier gas Split Ratio 16:1, N 2 flow at 15 ml/min., N 2 velocity at 18 cm/sec.
  • the temperature program is 70° C. for 0-3 min, 70-300° C. from 3-10 min, 300° C. from 10-15 min.
  • HPLC analysis was performed on a Gilson 322 Pump, detector UV/is-156 at 360 nm, equipped with a Microsorb MV C8 column, 100 A, 25 cm.
  • the product mixture was then evaporated to approximately 500 mL and transferred to a 2 L separatory funnel with ethyl acetate while decanting away from the solids.
  • the aqueous layer was extracted with ethyl acetate (3 ⁇ 1 L).
  • the extracts were combined, washed with brine, dried over sodium sulfate, filtered and evaporated to afford 265 g of the crude product.
  • a portion of the crude product (130 g) was chromatographed (silica gel, 5:1 hexanes/ethyl acetate) using toluene to load the column. The remaining crude material was crystallized from 1:1 toluene/heptane.
  • N-Cbz-4-(4-hydroxyphenyl)butylamine (31) (30 g, 0.10 mole), glycidol (8.0 mL, 0.12 mole) ethanol (30 mL) and triethylamine (0.7 mL, 0.005 mole) were stirred at reflux under argon for 2 h.
  • the product mixture was evaporated, taken up in hot ethyl acetate and suction filtered through a plug of silica gel, eluting with ethyl acetate. After evaporating to a white solid, this solid was re-crystallized from toluene to afford 21.8 g (58%) of compound (31).
  • N-Cbz-4-[4-(2,3-dihydroxypropyloxy)phenyl]butylamine (31) (67 g, 0.179 mole), ethanol (900 mL), acetic acid (50 mL) and 50% wet 10% palladium on carbon (10 g) were stirred at atmospheric pressure under H 2 . After stirring overnight, the reaction was purged with nitrogen and suction filtered through a pad of celite. This was evaporated and then co-evaporated 3 times with ethanol (500 mL). The residue was chromatographed (silica gel, 100:10:1 methylene chloride/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) to afford 38 g (89%) of pure compound (32).
  • Acetic anhydride (0.6 ml, 6 mmol) was added to solution of 31 (0.55 g, 1.5 mmol) in dry pyridine (50 mL) under stirring. The reaction mixture was stirred 3 h at 25° C. and 3 h at 40° C. (oil bath). After this time, the reaction was quenched with 2N HCl (100 mL) and extracted with ethyl acetate. The organic fraction was washed with water and dried over sodium sulfate. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure to provide 34 (0.6 g 86%) as a white powder.
  • 2,3,4-Tri-O-acetyl- ⁇ -D-glucuronic acid methyl ester trichloroimidate (1.6 g, 3.3 mmol) was added under argon to protected aminophenol 29 in dry methylene chloride (40 mL) then the solution was cooled to ⁇ 25° C. After stirring for 10 min, BF 3 .OEt 2 (0.045 mL, 0.33 mmol) was added in methylene chloride (5 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred 1.5 h at ⁇ 25° C., then allowed to warn up to ⁇ 10° C. and stirring was continued 1 h at that temperature. After this time, the temperature was increased to 25° C.
  • Glucuronide 38 (1.5 g, 2.4 mmol) was dissolved in dry methanol (100 mL) and Pd/C (0.62 g, 5%) was added. The reaction mixture was stirred under hydrogen (1 atm) for 2.5 h at room temperature. After this time, the solution was passed through a pad of silica gel and the solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure to give amine 39 (0.94 g, 84%).
  • the target compound 40 (0.32 g, 48%) was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, 12:1:0.1 chloroform/ethanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) and isolated as a yellow powder.
  • 1 H NMR 300 MHz, CDCl 3 ) ⁇ 1.61 (br s, 4H), 2.05 (s, 9H), 2.55 (m, 2H), 3.49 (br s, 2H), 3.71 (m, 3H), 4.22 (m, 1H), 5.12 (m, 1H), 5.34 (m, 3H), 6.88 (m, 2H), 7 04 (d, 2H).
  • APCI MS m/z 694 [C 29 H 36 ClN 7 O 11 +H] + .
  • Lithium aluminum hydride (LAH) (55 mL of a 1.0 M solution in THF, 0.055 mol) was added drop wise to a solution of 2 (7.6 g, 0.037 mol) in dry THF (70 mL) at 0° C. The mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature in an argon atmosphere then the mixture was treated with water (1.5 mL), then 15% NaOH (1.5 mL), then with more water (3 mL) and filtered. The solid precipitate was washed with THF. The combined organic fractions were dried over magnesium sulfate and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure to give 6.2 g (94%) of 3. The purity of 3 (99%) was determined by GC.
  • LAH Lithium aluminum hydride
  • the reaction was run at room temperature with periodic shaking by hand and was stopped by the addition of an equal volume of MeCN after 42 h.
  • the reaction solution was divided into two (50 mL) centrifuge tubes and centrifuged to remove the enzyme.
  • the precipitated enzyme was re-suspended in MeCN (40 mL) and centrifuged again. This enzyme wash was repeated 3 times until the LC/MS analysis showed only trace amounts of remaining product.
  • the supernatants were combined and the aqueous MeCN was removed under vacuum at 30° C. The resulting syrup was thinned by the addition of MeCN and further dried under vacuum overnight.
  • Lithium aluminum hydride 35 mL of a 1.0 M solution in THF, 0.035 mol was added drop wise to a vigorously stirred solution of 4-(4-carboxymethylphenyl)butylazide 8 (2.4 g, 0.010 mol) in dry THF (120 mL) at 0° C. and stirred overnight at room temperature under a nitrogen atmosphere.
  • To break up the complex water 1.5 mL
  • 15% NaOH (1.5 mL) and water 4.5 mL were added drop wise to the cold reaction mixture.
  • the white solid precipitate was filtered off and washed with THF. All organics phases were combined and evaporated.
  • N-Cbz-4-(4-allyloxyphenyl)butylamine 30 (1.94 g, 5.7 mmol) under a nitrogen atmosphere was added cold (0° C.) AD-Mix- ⁇ (12 g) in tert-butanol (100 mL) and water (100 mL). The mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature overnight. The mixture was then quenched with saturated sodium sulfite (200 mL), extracted with ethyl acetate (3 ⁇ 100 mL), dried (Na 2 SO 4 ) and concentrated to give 69 (2 g, 95%) as a beige solid.
  • N-Cbz-4-(4-allyloxyphenyl)butylamine 30 (1.53 g, 4.5 mmol) under a nitrogen atmosphere was added cold (0° C.) AD-Mix- ⁇ (9.2 g) in tert-butanol (100 mL) and water (100 mL). The mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature overnight. The mixture was quenched with saturated sodium sulfite (200 mL), extracted with ethyl acetate (3 ⁇ 100 mL), dried (Na 2 SO 4 ) and concentrated to provide 72 (1.67 g, 99%) as a beige solid.
  • Tetraethyleneglycol monomethyl ether (2.0 g, 9.6 mmol) was combined with pyridine (0.93 mL, 11.5 mmol) in methylene chloride (20 mL) at 0° C.
  • p-Toluenesulfonyl chloride (2.2 g, 11.5 mmol) dissolved in methylene chloride (10 mL) was added dropwise and the reaction was allowed to warm to room temperature as the ice bath thawed. After stirring nine days, the product mixture was transferred to a separatory funnel with water (70 mL). The layers were separated and the aqueous layer was extracted with methylene chloride (3 ⁇ 20 mL). The extracts were combined and evaporated.
  • 2-(4-Bromophenoxy)ethanol (3 g, 14.5 mmol), palladium (II) chloride (0.2 g, 1.1 mmol) and triphenylphosphine (0.6 g, 2.2 mmol) were dissolved in triethylamine (70 mL) then copper(I) iodide (0.45 g, 2.1 mmol) and N-(but-3-yn)phthalimide (3.2 g, 16 mmol) were added. The reaction mixture was stirred for 72 h at room temperature and 5 h at 50° C. (oil bath), then the solvent was removed under reduced pressure.
  • the crude protected amine 114 (1.2 g, 35 mmol) was dissolved in 40 mL of a 2 N solution of methyl amine in dry methanol and the reaction mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature. After this time the solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, 5:1:0.1 chloroform/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) to give free amine 115 (0.25 g, 35%) as a clear oil.
  • Aerosols of 99m Tc-Human serum albumin (3.1 mg/ml; containing approximately 20 mCi) were generated using a Raindrop Nebulizer which produces a droplet with a median aerodynamic diameter of 3.6 ⁇ m.
  • the nebulizer was connected to a dosimetry system consisting of a solenoid valve and a source of compressed air (20 psi).
  • the output of the nebulizer was directed into a plastic T connector; one end of which was connected to the endotracheal tube, the other was connected to a piston respirator. The system was activated for one second at the onset of the respirator's inspiratory cycle.
  • the respirator was set at a tidal volume of 500 mL, an inspiratory to expiratory ratio of 1:1, and at a rate of 20 breaths per minute to maximize the central airway deposition.
  • the sheep breathed the radio-labeled aerosol for 5 minutes.
  • a gamma camera was used to measure the clearance of 99m Tc-Human serum albumin from the airways. The camera was positioned above the animal's back with the sheep in a natural upright position supported in a cart so that the field of image was perpendicular to the animal's spinal cord. External radio-labeled markers were placed on the sheep to ensure proper alignment under the gamma camera. All images were stored in a computer integrated with the gamma camera.
  • Treatment Protocol (Assessment of activity at t-zero): A baseline deposition image was obtained immediately after radio-aerosol administration. At time zero, after acquisition of the baseline image, vehicle control (distilled water), positive control (amiloride), or experimental compounds were aerosolized from a 4 ml volume using a Pari LC JetPlus nebulizer to free-breathing animals.
  • the nebulizer was driven by compressed air with a flow of 8 liters per minute. The time to deliver the solution was 10 to 12 minutes. Animals were extubated immediately following delivery of the total dose in order to prevent false elevations in counts caused by aspiration of excess radio-tracer from the ETT. Serial images of the lung were obtained at 15-minute intervals during the first 2 hours after dosing and hourly for the next 6 hours after dosing for a total observation period of 8 hours, as shown in FIG. 1 . A washout period of at least 7 days separated dosing sessions with different experimental agents.
  • Treatment Protocol (Assessment of Activity at t-4 hours): The following variation of the standard protocol was used to assess the durability of response following a single exposure to vehicle control (distilled water), positive control compounds (amiloride or benzamil), or investigational agents. At time zero, vehicle control (distilled water), positive control (amiloride), or investigational compounds were aerosolized from a 4 ml volume using a Pari LC JetPlus nebulizer to free-breathing animals. The nebulizer was driven by compressed air with a flow of 8 liters per minute. The time to deliver the solution was 10 to 12 minutes. Animals were restrained in an upright position in a specialized body harness for 4 hours.
  • mice received a single dose of aerosolized 99m Tc-Human serum albumin (3.1 mg/ml; containing approximately 20 mCi) from a Raindrop Nebulizer. Animals were extubated immediately following delivery of the total dose of radio-tracer. A baseline deposition image was obtained immediately after radio-aerosol administration. Serial images of the lung were obtained at 15-minute intervals during the first 2 hours after administration of the radio-tracer (representing hours 4 through 6 after drug administration) and hourly for the next 2 hours after dosing for a total observation period of 4 hours, as shown in FIG. 2 . A washout period of at least 7 days separated dosing sessions with different experimental agents. Statistics: Data were analyzed using SYSTAT for Windows, version 5.
  • Diisopropylazodicarboxylate (132 mL) was added dropwise over 45 minutes to a stirring mixture of [4-(4-hydroxyphenyl)butyl]carbamic acid benzyl ester (50 g, 0.167 mol), (2-hydroxyethyl)carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (103.4 mL, 0.668 mol), and THF (150 mL) with ice-methanol bath cooling from 15 to 35° C. When the exothermic reaction ceased, the cooling bath was removed, and the reaction was allowed to stir at room temperature overnight. The solvent was evaporated at reduced pressure, and the residue was applied to a 1 kg column of silica gel and eluted with methylene chloride.
  • Triethylamine (1.4 mL, 10 mmole) was dripped, via a syringe, into a stirring solution of N- ⁇ 4-[4-(2-aminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl ⁇ -N-(3,5-diamino-6-chloro-pyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine 4 (500 mg, 0.943 mmole) in methanol (3 mL).
  • 1,3-diBoc-2-(trifluoromethanesulfonyl)guanidine (Goodman's Reagent) (406 mg, 1.04 mmole), and this was allowed to stir at room temperature.
  • Method A via the reaction of ⁇ 4-[4-(2-aminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl ⁇ carbamic acid benzyl ester 7 with D-( ⁇ )-erythrose.
  • Acetic acid (0.18 mL, 3.08 mmol) and D-( ⁇ )-erythrose (0.74 g, 6.16 mmol) were sequentially added into a suspension of ⁇ 4-[4-(2-aminoethoxy)phenyl]-butyl ⁇ carbamic acid benzyl ester hydrochloride 7 (0.58 g, 1.54 mmol) in methanol (20 mL).
  • the reaction mixture was stirred for 20 minutes at room temperature and under nitrogen atmosphere; then sodium cyanoborohydride (0.39 g, 6.16 mmol) was added at ⁇ 78° C. The reaction was allowed to warm up to room temperature.
  • the compound 8 (0.30 g, 0.55 mmol) was dissolved in methanol (30 mL) and stirred with 10% palladium on carbon (0.24 g. wet) for 4 h at room temperature and atmospheric pressure of hydrogen. The mixture was then filtered through a silica gel pad; the solvent was evaporated to provide 9 (0.21 g, 92%) as a white solid.
  • Method B via the reaction of N- ⁇ 4-[4-(2-aminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl ⁇ -N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine 4 with D-( ⁇ )-erythrose.
  • the compound 4 (0.2 g, 0.48 mmol) was suspended in 7 mL of methanol and D-( ⁇ )-erythrose (0.17 g, 1.4 mmol) dissolved in 0.9 mL of methanol was added.
  • the reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 30 min. After this time 25 ⁇ L of acetic acid was added to give a clear solution.
  • the reaction mixture was cooled to ⁇ 78° C. and sodium cyanoborohydride (0.084 g, 1.4 mmol) was added.
  • the reaction was stirred at ⁇ 78° C. for 2 h and at room temperature for 3 d. After this time the solvent was removed under reduced pressure and 15 mL of water was added to the oily residue.
  • the oil transformed into a yellow solid after 18 h in refrigerator. The solid was isolated by centrifugation, washed with water and dissolved in MeOH containing 0.05 mL of TFA. Silica gel (approx. 20 mL) was added and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure.
  • the free base 4 (0.15 g, 0.35 mmol) was suspended in 6 mL of methanol. 2,4-Ethylidene-D-erythrose 1 (0.15 g, 1.05 mmol) in 2 mL of methanol was added, followed by the addition of 20 ⁇ L (0.35 mmol) of acetic acid. The mixture was stirred at room temperature until a clear solution was formed (approx. 10 min). The reaction solution was cooled to ⁇ 78° C. and sodium cyanoborohydride (0.07 g, 1.05 mmol) was added. The reaction mixture was stirred at ⁇ 78° C. for 2 h and at room temperature for 2 d.
  • the compound 7 (0.5 g, 1.32 mmol) was suspended in 8 mL of methanol. 2,4-Ethylidene-D-erythrose (0.6 g, 4.1 mmol) in 2 mL of methanol was added, followed by the addition of 80 ⁇ L (1.32 mmol) of acetic acid. The mixture was stirred at room temperature until a clear solution was formed (approx. 10 min). The reaction solution was cooled to ⁇ 78° C. and sodium cyanoborohydride (0.260 g, 1.05 mmol) was added. The reaction mixture was stirred at ⁇ 78° C. for 2 h and at room temperature for 18 h.
  • the solid was dissolved in 2.5 mL of 5% HCl and the solvent removed under reduced pressure.
  • the residue was dissolved in 1.5 mL of methanol and the methanol solution was poured into 2-propyl alcohol. The formed precipitate was collected, washed with methylene chloride and dried in vacuum.
  • the suspension was allowed to warm up to room temperature by removing the ice bath, and the stirring was continued for one more hour.
  • the solid was vacuum filtered, washed with MTBE (3 ⁇ 5 mL), and tried under vacuum for 4 hours.
  • the dry material (0.155 g) was then suspended in ethanol (3 mL), and treated with concentrated HCl (1 mL). Water (3 mL) was added to completely dissolve the solid. The resulting solution was concentrated to dryness under vacuum. The residue was taken into methanol (2 mL).
  • the resultant methanolic solution was added into 2-propyl alcohol (15 mL) at room temperature. The resulting light yellow suspension was stirred at room temperature overnight.
  • Benzyl chloroformate (26 mL, 0.176 mole) was added in one portion to a stirring mixture of bromoethylamine hydrobromide (44 g, 0.21 mole), triethylamine (64 mL, 0.46 mole), and methylene chloride (1 L) at below ⁇ 40° C. After the addition, the cooling bath was removed, and the reaction was allowed to stir for 3 h. The mixture was transferred to a 2 L separatory funnel, and sequentially washed with water (2 ⁇ 500 mL), 2N HCl (250 mL), and water (500 mL). The resulting solution was suction filtered through a 100 g pad of silica gel and washed with methylene chloride.
  • the compound 19 (0.15 g, 0.331 mmol) was mixed with ethanol (5 mL). The mixture was heated at 65° C. for 15 min to achieve complete dissolution. To the clear solution were sequentially added di-isopropylethylamine (0.26 mL, 1.505 mmol) and 1-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl)-2-methylisothiourea hydriodide (0.117 g, 0.301 mmol). The mixture was heated at 65° C. for an additional 2 hours, and subsequently concentrated under vacuum.
  • the free base 4 (0.3 g, 0.71 mmol) was suspended in 12 mL of methanol and 0.09 mL (1.4 mmol) of AcOH was added. The mixture was stirred at room temperature until a clear solution was formed. 2,4-Ethylidene-D-erythrose (0.13 g, 0.92 mmol) was then added. The reaction solution was cooled to ⁇ 78° C. and sodium cyanoborohydride (0.06 g, 0.92 mmol) was added. The reaction mixture was stirred at ⁇ 78° C. for 2 h and then at room temperature for 18 h.
  • 1,1′-Carbonyldiimidazole (0.6 g, 3.71 mmol) was added into the solution of 26 (0.91 g, 3.09 mmol) in THF (50 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight under argon atmosphere, then ethanolamine (0.28 mL, 4.64 mmol) was added. The stirring was continued for 24 h at room temperature and argon atmosphere. The solvent was evaporated and the residue was purified by FlashTM (BIOTAGE, Inc) (90 g silica gel cartridge 40M, 18:1:0.1 chloroform/ethanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide). 0.74 g (71%) of a white solid 27 was isolated.
  • FlashTM BIOTAGE, Inc
  • the free base of the target compound 29 (0.36 g, 62%) was purified by FlashTM (BIOTAGE, Inc) (90 g silica gel cartridge 40M, 12:1:0.1 chloroform/ethanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) as a yellow solid. 100 mg of the yellow solid was treated with 2 mL of 3% HCl. The precipitate was collected by filtration, washed with water (2 ⁇ 5 mL) and dried under vacuum to give 85 mg (79%) of 29 as a yellow powder.
  • FlashTM BIOTAGE, Inc
  • But-3-ynylcarbamic acid tert-butyl ester (3.66 g, 22 mmol) was added dropwise to an ice cooled, stirring, argon purged mixture of 4-iodobenzonitrile (4.5 g, 19.6 mmol), dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(II) (0.69 g, 0.98 mmol), copper (I) iodide (0.19 g, 0.98 mmol), triethylamine (11 mL, 78.4 mmol), and THF (24 mL). After stirring for 10 min, the ice bath was removed, and the reaction was allowed to stir for an additional 2 h.
  • the reaction mixture was then purged with nitrogen, transferred to a separatory funnel with ethyl acetate (500 mL), and sequentially washed with water (3 ⁇ 100 mL), saturated aqueous solution of potassium hydrogen sulfate (3 ⁇ 100 mL), water (2 ⁇ 50 mL), and brine (2 ⁇ 50 mL). The solution was dried over sodium sulfate. The solid was filtered, and the filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting solid was re-crystallized from hexanes/ethyl acetate (10:1), and placed under vacuum for 2 h to afford the pure product 58 (4.8 g, 95%) as a yellow crystalline solid.
  • X Fold Amiloride* NH 2 56.5 ⁇ 24 (4) NH—C( ⁇ NH)—NH 2 120.6 ⁇ 60.8 (11) NHSO 2 CH 3 64.0 (1) NHCO 2 (CH 3 ) 3 51.7 ⁇ 10.1 (2) NHCOCH 3 48.5 ⁇ 26.5 (4)

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Pulmonology (AREA)
  • Molecular Biology (AREA)
  • Crystallography & Structural Chemistry (AREA)
  • Biochemistry (AREA)
  • Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
  • Biotechnology (AREA)
  • Reproductive Health (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Dermatology (AREA)
  • Diabetes (AREA)
  • Hematology (AREA)
  • Urology & Nephrology (AREA)
  • Gynecology & Obstetrics (AREA)
  • Endocrinology (AREA)
  • Cardiology (AREA)
  • Rheumatology (AREA)
  • Pain & Pain Management (AREA)
  • Toxicology (AREA)
  • Otolaryngology (AREA)
  • Heart & Thoracic Surgery (AREA)
  • Ophthalmology & Optometry (AREA)
  • Pregnancy & Childbirth (AREA)
  • Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
  • Medicines That Contain Protein Lipid Enzymes And Other Medicines (AREA)

Abstract

The present invention relates to use of a compound represented by formula (I):
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00001
in which at least one of R3 and R4 is a group represented by formula (A):
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00002
where the structural variables are as defined herein. The compounds are useful for blocking sodium channels and treating a variety of conditions.

Description

    CONTINUING APPLICATION INFORMATION
  • This application is a Continuation of U.S. application Ser. No. 11/695,936, filed on Apr. 3, 2007, which is a Divisional of U.S. application Ser. No. 10/828,479, filed on Apr. 21, 2004, which is a Divisional application of Ser. No. 10/076,571, filed on Feb. 19, 2002. This application is incorporated herein by reference.
  • BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
  • 1. Field of the Invention
  • The present invention relates to sodium channel blockers. The present invention also includes a variety of methods of treatment using these inventive sodium channel blockers.
  • 2. Description of the Background
  • The mucosal surfaces at the interface between the environment and the body have evolved a number of “innate defense”, i.e., protective mechanisms. A principal form of such innate defense is to cleanse these surfaces with liquid. Typically, the quantity of the liquid layer on a mucosal surface reflects the balance between epithelial liquid secretion, often reflecting anion (Cl and/or HCO3 ) secretion coupled with water (and a cation counter-ion), and epithelial liquid absorption, often reflecting Na+ absorption, coupled with water and counter anion (Cl and/or HCO3—). Many diseases of mucosal surfaces are caused by too little protective liquid on those mucosal surfaces created by an imbalance between secretion (too little) and absorption (relatively too much). The defective salt transport processes that characterize these mucosal dysfunctions reside in the epithelial layer of the mucosal surface.
  • One approach to replenish the protective liquid layer on mucosal surfaces is to “re-balance” the system by blocking Na+ channel and liquid absorption. The epithelial protein that mediates the rate-limiting step of Na+ and liquid absorption is the epithelial Na+ channel (ENaC). ENaC is positioned on the apical surface of the epithelium, i.e. the mucosal surface-environmental interface. Therefore, to inhibit ENaC mediated Na+ and liquid absorption, an ENaC blocker of the amiloride class (which blocks from the extracellular domain of ENaC) must be delivered to the mucosal surface and, importantly, be maintained at this site, to achieve therapeutic utility. The present invention describes diseases characterized by too little liquid on mucosal surfaces and “topical” sodium channel blockers designed to exhibit the increased potency, reduced mucosal absorption, and slow dissociation (“unbinding” or detachment) from ENaC required for therapy of these diseases.
  • Chronic bronchitis (CB), including the most common lethal genetic form of chronic bronchitis, cystic fibrosis (CF), are diseases that reflect the body's failure to clear mucus normally from the lungs, which ultimately produces chronic airways infection. In the normal lung, the primary defense against chronic intrapulmonary airways infection (chronic bronchitis) is mediated by the continuous clearance of mucus from bronchial airway surfaces. This function in health effectively removes from the lung potentially noxious toxins and pathogens. Recent data indicate that the initiating problem, i.e., the “basic defect,” in both CB and CF is the failure to clear mucus from airway surfaces. The failure to clear mucus reflects an imbalance between the amount of liquid and mucin on airway surfaces. This “airway surface liquid” (ASL) is primarily composed of salt and water in proportions similar to plasma (i.e., isotonic). Mucin macromolecules organize into a well defined “mucus layer” which normally traps inhaled bacteria and is transported out of the lung via the actions of cilia which beat in a watery, low viscosity solution termed the “periciliary liquid” (PCL). In the disease state, there is an imbalance in the quantities of mucus as ASL on airway surfaces. This results in a relative reduction in ASL which leads to mucus concentration, reduction in the lubricant activity of the PCL, and a failure to clear mucus via ciliary activity to the mouth. The reduction in mechanical clearance of mucus from the lung leads to chronic bacterial colonization of mucus adherent to airway surfaces. It is the chronic retention of bacteria, the failure of local antimicrobial substances to kill mucus-entrapped bacteria on a chronic basis, and the consequent chronic inflammatory responses of the body to this type of surface infection, that lead to the syndromes of CB and CF.
  • The current afflicted population in the U.S. is 12,000,000 patients with the acquired (primarily from cigarette smoke exposure) form of chronic bronchitis and approximately 30,000 patients with the genetic form, cystic fibrosis. Approximately equal numbers of both populations are present in Europe. In Asia, there is little CF but the incidence of CB is high and, like the rest of the world, is increasing.
  • There is currently a large, unmet medical need for products that specifically treat CB and CF at the level of the basic defect that cause these diseases. The current therapies for chronic bronchitis and cystic fibrosis focus on treating the symptoms and/or the late effects of these diseases. Thus, for chronic bronchitis, β-agonists, inhaled steroids, anti-cholinergic agents, and oral theophyllines and phosphodiesterase inhibitors are all in development. However, none of these drugs treat effectively the fundamental problem of the failure to clear mucus from the lung. Similarly, in cystic fibrosis, the same spectrum of pharmacologic agents is used. These strategies have been complemented by more recent strategies designed to clear the CF lung of the DNA (“Pulmozyme”; Genentech) that has been deposited in the lung by neutrophils that have futilely attempted to kill the bacteria that grow in adherent mucus masses and through the use of inhaled antibiotics (“TOBI”) designed to augment the lungs' own killing mechanisms to rid the adherent mucus plaques of bacteria. A general principle of the body is that if the initiating lesion is not treated, in this case mucus retention/obstruction, bacterial infections became chronic and increasingly refractory to antimicrobial therapy. Thus, a major unmet therapeutic need for both CB and CF lung diseases is an effective means of re-hydrating airway mucus (i.e., restoring/expanding the volume of the ASL) and promoting its clearance, with bacteria, from the lung.
  • R. C. Boucher, in U.S. Pat. No. 6,264,975, describes the use of pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers for hydrating mucosal surfaces. These compounds, typified by the well-known diuretics amiloride, benzamil, and phenamil, are effective. However, these compounds suffer from the significant disadvantage that they are (1) relatively impotent, which is important because the mass of drug that can be inhaled by the lung is limited; (2) rapidly absorbed, which limits the half-life of the drug on the mucosal surface; and (3) are freely dissociable from ENaC. The sum of these disadvantages embodied in these well known diurectics produces compounds with insufficient potency and/or effective half-life on mucosal surfaces to have therapeutic benefit for hydrating mucosal surfaces.
  • Clearly, what is needed are drugs that are more effective at restoring the clearance of mucus from the lungs of patients with CB/CF. The value of these new therapies will be reflected in improvements in the quality and duration of life for both the CF and the CB populations.
  • Other mucosal surfaces in and on the body exhibit subtle differences in the normal physiology of the protective surface liquids on their surfaces but the pathophysiology of disease reflects a common theme, i.e., too little protective surface liquid. For example, in xerostomia (dry mouth) the oral cavity is depleted of liquid due to a failure of the parotid sublingual and submandibular glands to secrete liquid despite continued Na+ (ENaC) transport mediated liquid absorption from the oral cavity. Similarly, keratoconjunctivitis sira (dry eye) is caused by failure of lacrimal glands to secrete liquid in the face of continued Na+ dependent liquid absorption on conjunctional surfaces. In rhinosinusitis, there is an imbalance, as in CB, between mucin secretion and relative ASL depletion. Finally, in the gastrointestinal tract, failure to secrete Cl− (and liquid) in the proximal small intestine, combined with increased Na+ (and liquid) absorption in the terminal ileum leads to the distal intestinal obstruction syndrome (DIOS). In older patients excessive Na+ (and volume) absorption in the descending colon produces constipation and diverticulitis.
  • Fifty million Americans and hundreds of millions of others around the world suffer from high blood pressure and the subsequent sequale leading to congestive heart failure and increasing mortality. It is the Western World's leading killer and there is a need there for new medicines to treat these diseases. Thus, in addition, some of the novel sodium channel blockers of this invention can be designed to target the kidney and as such they may be used as diuretics for the treatment of hypertension, congestive heart failure (CHF) and other cardiovascular diseases. These new agents may be used alone or in combination with beta-blockers, ACE inhibitors, HMGCoA reductase inhibitors, calcium channel blockers and other cardiovascular agents.
  • SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • It is an object of the present invention to provide compounds that are more potent and/or absorbed less rapidly from mucosal surfaces, and/or are less reversible as compared to known compounds.
  • It is another aspect of the present invention to provide compounds that are more potent and/or absorbed less rapidly and/or exhibit less reversibility, as compared to compounds such as amilorde, benzamil, and phenamil. Therefore, the compounds will give a prolonged pharmacodynamic half-life on mucosal surfaces as compared to known compounds.
  • It is another object of the present invention to provide compounds which are (1) absorbed less rapidly from mucosal surfaces, especially airway surfaces, as compared to known compounds and; (2) when absorbed from musosal surfaces after administration to the mucosal surfaces, are converted in vivo into metabolic derivitives thereof which have reduced efficacy in blocking sodium channels as compared to the administered parent compound. It is another object of the present invention to provide compounds that are more potent and/or absorbed less rapidly and/or exhibit less reversibility, as compared to compounds such as amiloride, benzamil, and phenamil. Therefore, such compounds will give a prolonged pharmacodynamic half-life on mucosal surfaces as compared to previous compounds.
  • It is another object of the present invention to provide compounds that target the kidney for use in the treatment of cardiovascular disease.
  • It is another object of the present invention to provide methods of treatment that take advantage of the pharmacological properties of the compounds described above.
  • In particular, it is an object of the present invention to provide methods of treatment which rely on rehydration of mucosal surfaces.
  • In particular, it is an object of the present invention to provide methods of treating cardiovascular disease.
  • The objects of the present invention may be accomplished with a class of pyrazinoylguanidine compounds represented by formula (I):
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00003
  • where
  • X is hydrogen, halogen, trifluoromethyl, lower alkyl, unsubstituted or substituted phenyl, lower alkyl-thio, phenyl-lower alkyl-thio, lower alkyl-sulfonyl, or phenyl-lower alkyl-sulfonyl;
  • Y is hydrogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, lower alkoxy, lower alkyl-thio, halogen, lower alkyl, unsubstituted or substituted mononuclear aryl, or —N(R2)2;
  • R1 is hydrogen or lower alkyl;
  • each R2 is, independently, —R7, —(CH2)m—OR8, —(CH2)m—NR7R10, —(CH2)n(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, (CH2CH2O)m—R8, —(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —(CH2)n—C(═O)NR7R10, —(CH2)n-Zg-R7, —(CH2)m—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2)n—CO2R7, or
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00004
  • R3 and R4 are each, independently, hydrogen, a group represented by formula (A), lower alkyl, hydroxy lower alkyl, phenyl, phenyl-lower alkyl, (halophenyl)-lower alkyl, lower-(alkylphenylalkyl), lower (alkoxyphenyl)-lower alkyl, naphthyl-lower alkyl, or pyridyl-lower alkyl, with the proviso that at least one of R3 and R4 is a group represented by formula (A):
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00005
  • where
      • each RL is, independently, —R7, —(CH2)n—OR8, —O—(CH2)m—OR8, —(CH2)n—NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—NR7R10, —(CH2)n(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —(CH2)n—C(═O)NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—C(═O)NR7R10, —(CH2)n-(Z)g-R7, —O—(CH2)m-(Z)g-R7, —(CH2)n—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2)n—CO2R7, —O—(CH2)m—CO2R7, —OSO3H, —O-glucuronide, —O-glucose,
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00006
      • each o is, independently, an integer from 0 to 10;
      • each p is an integer from 0 to 10;
  • with the proviso that the sum of o and p in each contiguous chain is from 1 to 10;
      • each x is, independently, O, NR10, C(═O), CHOH, C(═N—R10), CHNR7R10, or represents a single bond;
      • each R5 is, independently, —(CH2)m—OR8, —O—(CH2)m—OR8, —(CH2)n—NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—NR7R10, —(CH2)n(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R7R10, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —(CH2)n—C(═O)NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—C(═O)NR7R10, —(CH2)n-(Z)g-R7, —O—(CH2)m-(Z)g-R7, —(CH2)n—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2)n—CO2R7, —O—(CH2)m—CO2R7, —OSO3H, —O-glucuronide, —O-glucose,
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00007
  • each R6 is, independently, —R7, —OR11, —N(R7)2, —(CH2)m—OR8, —O—(CH2)m—OR8, —(CH2)n—NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—NR7R7R10, —(CH2)n(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —(CH2)n—C(═O)NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—C(═O)NR7R10, —(CH2)n-(Z)g-R7—O—(CH2)m-(Z)g-R7, —(CH2)n—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2)n—CO2R7, —O—(CH2)m—CO2R7, —OSO3H, —O-glucuronide, —O-glucose,
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00008
  • where when two R6 are —OR11 and are located adjacent to each other on a phenyl ring, the alkyl moieties of the two R6 may be bonded together to form a methylenedioxy group;
      • each R7 is, independently, hydrogen or lower alkyl;
      • each R8 is, independently, hydrogen, lower alkyl, —C(═O)—R11, glucuronide, 2-tetrahydropyranyl, or
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00009
      • each R9 is, independently, —CO2R7, —CON(R7)2, —SO2CH3, or —C(═O)R7;
      • each R10 is, independently, —H, —SO2CH3, —CO2R7, —C(═O)NR7R9, —C(═O)R7, or —CH2—(CHOH)n—CH2OH;
      • each Z is, independently, CHOH, C(═O), CHNR7R10, C═NR10, or NR10;
      • each R11 is, independently, lower alkyl;
      • each g is, independently, an integer from 1 to 6;
      • each m is, independently, an integer from 1 to 7;
      • each n is, independently, an integer from 0 to 7;
      • each Q is, independently, C—R5, C—R6, or a nitrogen atom, wherein at
      • most three Q in a ring are nitrogen atoms;
  • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and
  • inclusive of all enantiomers, diastereomers, and racemic mixtures thereof.
  • The present also provides pharmaceutical compositions which contain a compound described above.
  • The present invention also provides a method of promoting hydration of mucosal surfaces, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to a mucosal surface of a subject.
  • The present invention also provides a method of restoring mucosal defense, comprising:
  • topically administering an effective amount of compound represented by formula (I) to a mucosal surface of a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of blocking ENaC, comprising:
  • contacting sodium channels with an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I).
  • The present invention also provides a method of promoting mucus clearance in mucosal surfaces, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to a mucosal surface of a subject.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating chronic bronchitis, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating cystic fibrosis, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating rhinosinusitis, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by a formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating nasal dehydration, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to the nasal passages of a subject in need thereof.
  • In a specific embodiment, the nasal dehydration is brought on by administering dry oxygen to the subject.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating sinusitis, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating pneumonia, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of preventing ventilator-induced pneumonia, comprising:
  • administering an effective compound represented by formula (I) to a subject by means of a ventilator.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating asthma, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating primary ciliary dyskinesia, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating otitis media, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of inducing sputum for diagnostic purposes, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating chronic obstructive pulmonary disease, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating emphysema, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating dry eye, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to the eye of the subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of promoting ocular hydration, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to the eye of the subject.
  • The present invention also provides a method of promoting corneal hydration, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to the eye of the subject.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating Sjögren's disease, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating vaginal dryness, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to the vaginal tract of a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating dry skin, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to the skin of a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating dry mouth (xerostomia), comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of compound represented by formula (I) to the mouth of the subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating distal intestinal obstruction syndrome, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating esophagitis, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating constipation, comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof. In one embodiment of this method, the compound is administered either orally or via a suppository or enema.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating chronic diverticulitis comprising:
  • administering an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating hypertension, comprising administering the compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of reducing blood pressure, comprising administering the compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of treating edema, comprising administering the compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of promoting diuresis, comprising administering the compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of promoting natriuresis, comprising administering the compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • The present invention also provides a method of promoting saluresis, comprising administering the compound represented by formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE FIGURES
  • A more complete appreciation of the invention and many of the attendant advantages thereof will be readily obtained as the same becomes better understood by reference to the following detailed description considered in conjunction with the following figures:
  • FIG. 1: Effect of a compound of the present invention on MCC at t=0 hrs as described in Example 32 herein.
  • FIG. 2: Effect of a compound of the present invention on MCC at t=4 hrs as described in Example 32 herein.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE INVENTION
  • The present invention is based on the discovery that the compounds of formula (I) are more potent and/or, absorbed less rapidly from mucosal surfaces, especially airway surfaces, and/or less reversible from interactions with ENaC as compared to compounds such as amiloride, benzamil, and phenamil. Therefore, the compounds of formula (I) have a longer half-life on mucosal surfaces as compared to these compounds.
  • The present invention is also based on the discovery that certain compounds embraced by formula (I) are converted in vivo into metabolic derivatives thereof that have reduced efficacy in blocking sodium channels as compared to the parent administered compound, after they are absorbed from mucosal surfaces after administration. This important property means that the compounds will have a lower tendency to cause undesired side-effects by blocking sodium channels located at untargeted locations in the body of the recipient, e.g., in the kidneys.
  • The present invention is also based on the discovery that certain compounds embraced by formula (I) target the kidney and thus may be used as cardiovascular agents.
  • In the compounds represented by formula (I), X may be hydrogen, halogen, trifluoromethyl, lower alkyl, lower cycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted phenyl, lower alkyl-thio, phenyl-lower alkyl-thio, lower alkyl-sulfonyl, or phenyl-lower alkyl-sulfonyl. Halogen is preferred.
  • Examples of halogen include fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine. Chlorine and bromine are the preferred halogens. Chlorine is particularly preferred. This description is applicable to the term “halogen” as used throughout the present disclosure.
  • As used herein, the term “lower alkyl” means an alkyl group having less than 8 carbon atoms. This range includes all specific values of carbon atoms and subranges there between, such as 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, and 7 carbon atoms. The term “alkyl” embraces all types of such groups, e.g., linear, branched, and cyclic alkyl groups. This description is applicable to the term “lower alkyl” as used throughout the present disclosure. Examples of suitable lower alkyl groups include methyl, ethyl, propyl, cyclopropyl, butyl, isobutyl, etc.
  • Substituents for the phenyl group include halogens. Particularly preferred halogen substituents are chlorine and bromine.
  • Y may be hydrogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, lower alkoxy, lower alkyl-thio, halogen, lower alkyl, lower cycloalkyl, mononuclear aryl, or —N(R2)2. The alkyl moiety of the lower alkoxy groups is the same as described above. Examples of mononuclear aryl include phenyl groups. The phenyl group may be unsubstituted or substituted as described above. The preferred identity of Y is —N(R2)2. Particularly preferred are such compounds where each R2 is hydrogen.
  • R1 may be hydrogen or lower alkyl. Hydrogen is preferred for R1.
  • Each R2 may be, independently, —R7, —(CH2)m—OR8, —(CH2)m—NR7R10, —(CH2)n(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —(CH2)n—C(═O)NR7R10, —(CH2)n-Zg-R7, —(CH2)m—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2)n—CO2R7, or
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00010
  • Hydrogen and lower alkyl, particularly C1-C3 alkyl are preferred for R2. Hydrogen is particularly preferred.
  • R3 and R4 may be, independently, hydrogen, a group represented by formula (A), lower alkyl, hydroxy lower alkyl, phenyl, phenyl-lower alkyl, (halophenyl)-lower alkyl, lower-(alkylphenylalkyl), lower (alkoxyphenyl)-lower alkyl, naphthyl-lower alkyl, or pyridyl-lower alkyl, provided that at least one of R3 and R4 is a group represented by formula (A).
  • Preferred compounds are those where one of R3 and R4 is hydrogen and the other is represented by formula (A).
  • In formula (A), the moiety —(C(RL)2)o-x-(C(RL)2)p— defines an alkylene group bonded to the aromatic ring. The variables o and p may each be an integer from 0 to 10, subject to the proviso that the sum of o and p in the chain is from 1 to 10. Thus, o and p may each be 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10. Preferably, the sum of o and p is from 2 to 6. In a particularly preferred embodiment, the sum of o and p is 4.
  • The linking group in the alkylene chain, x, may be, independently, O, NR10, C(═O), CHOH, C(═N—R10), CHNR7R10, or represents a single bond;
  • Therefore, when x represents a single bond, the alkylene chain bonded to the ring is represented by the formula —(C(RL)2)o+p—, in which the sum o+p is from 1 to 10.
  • Each RL may be, independently, —R7, —(CH2)n—OR8, —O—(CH2)m—OR8, —(CH2)n—NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—NR7R10, —(CH2)n(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m(CHOR8)m(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —(CH2CH2O)m —CH2CH2NR7R10, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —(CH2)n—C(═O)NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—C(═O)NR7R10, —(CH2)n-(Z)g-R7, —O—(CH2)m-(Z)g-R7, —(CH2)n—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2)n—CO2R7, —O—(CH2)m—CO2R7, —OSO3H, —O-glucuronide, —O-glucose,
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00011
  • The preferred RL groups include —H, —OH, —N(R7)2, especially where each R7 is hydrogen.
  • In the alkylene chain in formula (A), it is preferred that when one RL group bonded to a carbon atoms is other than hydrogen, then the other RL bonded to that carbon atom is hydrogen, i.e., the formula —CHRL—. It is also preferred that at most two RL groups in an alkylene chain are other than hydrogen, where in the other RL groups in the chain are hydrogens. Even more preferably, only one RL group in an alkylene chain is other than hydrogen, where in the other RL groups in the chain are hydrogens. In these embodiments, it is preferable that x represents a single bond.
  • In another particular embodiment of the invention, all of the RL groups in the alkylene chain are hydrogen. In these embodiments, the alkylene chain is represented by the formula

  • —(CH2)o-x-(CH2)p
  • Each R5 may be, independently, —(CH2)m—OR8, —O—(CH2)m—OR8, —(CH2)n—NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—NR7R10, —(CH2)n(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2CH2)m—R8, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —(CH2)n—C(═O)NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—C(═O)NR7R10, —(CH2)n-(Z)g-R7, —O—(CH2)m-(Z)g-R7, —(CH2)n—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, O—(CH2)m—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2)n—CO2R7, —O—(CH2)m—CO2R7, —OSO3H, —O-glucuronide, —O-glucose,
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00012
  • Thus, R5 may be one of the following:
    • —(CH2)m—OR8,
    • para-(CH2)4—OH,
    • —O—(CH2)n—OR8,
    • para-O—(CH2)4—OH,
    • —(CH2)n—NR7R10,
    • para-NHSO2CH3,
    • para-CH2NH(C═O)—(OCH3)3,
    • para-NH(C═O)CH3,
    • para-CH2NH2,
    • para-NH—CO2C2H5,
    • para-CH2NH(C═O)CH3,
    • para-CH2NHCO2CH3,
    • para-CH2NHSO2CH3,
    • para-(CH2)4—NH(C═O)O(CH3)3,
    • para-(CH2)4—NH2,
    • para-(CH2)3—NH(C═O)O(CH3)3,
    • para-(CH2)3—NH2,
    • —O—(CH2)m—NR7R10,
    • para-OCH2CH2NHCO2(CH3)3,
    • para-OCH2CH2NHCO2C2H5,
    • para-O—(CH2)3—NH—CO2—(CH3)3,
    • para-O(CH2)3—NH2,
    • para-OCH2CH2NHSO2CH3,
    • —(CH2)n(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8,
    • —O—(CH2)m(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8,
    • para-OCH2CHOHCH2O-glucuronide,
    • para-OCH2CH2CHOHCH2OH,
    • para-OCH2-(α-CHOH)2CH2OH,
    • para-OCH2—(CHOH)2CH2OH,
    • —(CH2CH2O)m—R8,
    • —O—(CH2CH2O)m—R8,
    • —(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10,
    • O—(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10,
    • —(CH2)n—C(═O)NR7R10,
    • para-C(═O)NH2,
    • —O—(CH2)m—C(═O)NR7R10,
    • para-O—CH2—(C═O)NHCH2CHOH,
    • para-O—CH2—(C═O)NHCH2CHOHCH2OH,
    • para-O—CH2(C═O)NHCH2(CHOH)2CH2OH,
    • para-O—CH2C(C═O)NHSO2CH3,
    • para-O—CH2(C═O)NHCO2CH3,
    • para-O—CH2—C(C═O)NH—C(C═O)NH2,
    • —O—CH2—(C═O)NH—(C═O)CH3,
    • —(CH2)n-(Z)g-R7,
    • —(CH2)n—(C═N)—NH2,
    • para-(C═NH)NH2,
    • —(CH2)n—NH—C(═NH)—NH2,
    • para-(CH2)3—NH—C(═NH)—NH2,
    • para-CH2NH—C(═NH)—NH2,
    • —(CH2)n—CONHCH2(CHOH)n—CH2OH,
    • —NH—C(═O)—CH2—(CHOH)nCH2OH,
    • —NH—(C═O)—NH—CH2(CHOH)2CHOH,
    • para-NHC(C═O)NHCH2CH2OH,
    • —O—(CH2)m-(Z)g-R7,
    • —O—(CH2)m—NH—C(═NH)—N(R7)2,
    • para-O(CH2)3—NH—C(═NH)—NH2,
    • —O—(CH2)m—CHNH2—CO2NR7R10,
    • para-OCH2—CHNH2—CO2NH2,
    • —O—(CH2)m—CHNH2—CO2NR7R10, where the compound is the (R) enantiomer,
    • —O—(CH2)m—CHNH2—CO2NR7R10, where the compound is the (S) enantiomer,
    • para-OCH2CHOH—CH2NHCO2(CH3)3,
    • —(CH2)n—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8,
    • para-NHCH2(CHOH)2CH2OH,
    • —O—(CH2)m—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8,
    • —O—(CH2)m—CO2R7,
    • para-OCH2CH2CO2(CH3)3,
    • para-OCH2CO2H,
    • para-OCH2CO2C2H5,
    • —O—(CH2)m-Boc,
    • —(CH2)m-Boc,
    • —O—(CH2)m—NH—C(═NH)—N(R7)2,
    • —(CH2)n—NH—C(═NH)—N(R7)2,
    • —(CH2)m—NH—C(═O)—OR7,
    • —O—(CH2)m—NH—C(═O)—OR7,
    • —(CH2)n—NH—C(═O)—R11,
    • —O—(CH2)m—NH—C(═O)—R11,
    • —O—(CH2)m—C(═O)N(R7)2,
    • —(CH2)m—CHOH—CH2—NHBoc,
    • —O—(CH2)m—CHOH—CH2—NHBoc,
    • —(CH2)m—NHC(O)OR7,
    • —O—(CH2)m—NHC(O)OR7,
    • —O—(CH2)m—C(═NH)—N(R7)2,
    • —(CH2)n—C(═NH)—N(R7)2.
  • In another embodiment, R5 is selected from the group consisting of —O—(CH2)3—OH, —NH2, —O—CH2—(CHOH)2—CH2OH, —O—CH2—CHOH—CH2OH, —O—CH2CH2—O-tetrahydropyran-2-yl, —O—CH2CHOH—CH2—O-glucuronide, —O—CH2CH2OH, —O—(CH2CH2O)4—CH3, —O—CH2CH2OCH3, —O—CH2—(CHOC(═O)CH3)—CH2—OC(═O)CH3, —O—(CH2CH2O)2—CH3, —OCH2—CHOH—CHOH—CH2OH, —CH2OH, —CO2CH3,
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00013
  • In another embodiment, R5 is selected from the group consisting of para —O—(CH2)3—OH, para —NH2, para —O—CH2—(CHOH)2—CH2OH, ortho —O—CH2—CHOH—CH2OH, meta —O—CH2—CHOH—CH2OH, para —O—CH2CH2—O-tetrahydropyran-2-yl, para —O—CH2CHOH—CH2—O-glucuronide, para —O—CH2CH2OH, para —O—(CH2CH2O)4—CH3, para —O—CH2CH2OCH3, para —O—CH2—(CHOC(═O)CH3)—CH2—OC(═O)CH3, para —O—(CH2CH2O)2—CH3, —OCH2—CHOH—CHOH—CH2OH, para —CH2OH, para —CO2CH3, para —SO3H, para —O-glucuronide, para
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00014
  • In a preferred embodiment, each —(CH2)n-(Z)g-R7 falls within the scope of the structures described above and is, independently,
    • —(CH2)n—(C═N)—NH2,
    • —(CH2)n—NH—C(═NH)NH2,
    • —(CH2)n—CONHCH2(CHOH)n—CH2OH, or
    • —NH—C(═O)—CH2—(CHOH)nCH2OH.
  • In another a preferred embodiment, each —O—(CH2)m-(Z)g-R7 falls within the scope of the structures described above and is, independently,
    • —O—(CH2)m—NH—C(═NH)—N(R7)2, or
    • —O—(CH2)m—CHNH2—CO2NR17R10.
  • In another preferred embodiment, R5 may be one of the following: —O—CH2CHOHCH2O-glucuronide,
    • —OCH2CHOHCH3,
    • —OCH2CH2NH2,
    • —OCH2CH2NHCO(CH3)3,
    • —CH2CH2OH,
    • —OCH2CH2OH,
    • —O—(CH2)m-Boc,
    • —(CH2)m-Boc,
    • —OCH2CH2OH,
    • —OCH2CO2H,
    • O—(CH2)m—NH—C(═NH)—N(R7)2,
    • —(CH2)n—NH—C(═NH)—N(R7)2,
    • —NHCH2(CHOH)2—CH2OH,
    • —OCH2CO2Et,
    • —NHSO2CH3,
    • —(CH2)m—NH—C(═O)OR7,
    • —O—(CH2)m—NH—C(═O)—OR7,
    • —(CH2)n—NH—C(═O)—R11,
    • —O—(CH2)m—NH—C(═O)—R11,
    • —O—CH2C(═O)NH2,
    • —CH2NH2,
    • —NHCO2Et,
    • —OCH2CH2CH2CH2OH,
    • —CH2NHSO2CH3,
    • —OCH2CH2CHOHCH2OH,
    • —OCH2CH2NHCO2Et,
    • —NH—C(═NH2)—NH2,
    • —OCH2— (α-CHOH)2—CH2OH
    • —OCH2CHOHCH2NH2,
    • —(CH2)m—CHOH—CH2—NHBoc,
    • —O—(CH2)m—CHOH—CH2—NHBOc,
    • —(CH2)m—NHC(O)OR7,
    • —O—(CH2)m—NHC(O)OR7,
    • —OCH2CH2CH2NH2,
    • —OCH2CH2NHCH2(CHOH)2CH2OH,
    • —OCH2CH2NH(CH2[(CHOH)2CH20H)]2,
    • —(CH2)4—NHBoc,
    • —(CH2)4—NH2,
    • —(CH2)4—OH,
    • —OCH2CH2NHSO2CH3,
    • —O—(CH2)m—C(═NH)—N(R7)2,
    • —(CH2)n—C(═NH)—N(R7)2,
    • —(CH2)3—NH Boc,
    • —(CH2)3NH2,
    • —O—(CH2)m—NH—NH—C(═NH)—N(R7)2,
    • —(CH2)n—NH—NH—C(═NH)—N(R7)2, or
    • —O—CH2—CHOH—CH2—NH—C(═NH)—N(R7)2;
  • There are four R6 groups present on the ring in formula (A). Each R6 may be each, independently, —R7, —OR11, —N(R7)2, —(CH2)n—OR8,
    • —O—(CH2)m—OR8, —(CH2)n—NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—NR7R10,
    • —(CH2)n(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8,
    • —(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10,
    • —O—(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —(CH2)n—C(═O)NR7R10,
    • —O—(CH2)m—C(═O)NR7R10, —(CH2)n-(Z)g-R7, —O—(CH2)m-(Z)g-R7,
    • —(CH2)n—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8,
    • —O—(CH2)m—NR10 —CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8,
    • —(CH2)n—CO2R7, —O—(CH2)m—CO2R7, —OSO3H, —O-glucuronide, —O-glucose, or
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00015
  • In addition, one of more of the R6 groups can be one of the R5 groups which fall within the broad definition of R6 set forth above.
  • When two R6 are —OR11 and are located adjacent to each other on a phenyl ring, the alkyl moieties of the two R6 groups may be bonded together to form a methylenedioxy group, i.e., a group of the formula —O—CH2—O—.
  • As discussed above, R6 may be hydrogen. Therefore, 1, 2, 3, or 4 R6 groups may be other than hydrogen. Preferably at most 3 of the R6 groups are other than hydrogen.
  • Each g is, independently, an integer from 1 to 6. Therefore, each g may be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6.
  • Each m is an integer from 1 to 7. Therefore, each m may be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.
  • Each n is an integer from 0 to 7. Therefore, each n may be 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.
  • Each Q in formula (A) is C—R5, C—R6, or a nitrogen atom, where at most three Q in a ring are nitrogen atoms. Thus, there may be 1, 2, or 3 nitrogen atoms in a ring. Preferably, at most two Q are nitrogen atoms. More preferably, at most one Q is a nitrogen atom. In one particular embodiment, the nitrogen atom is at the 3-position of the ring. In another embodiment of the invention, each Q is either C—R5 or C—R6, i.e., there are no nitrogen atoms in the ring.
  • More specific examples of suitable groups represented by formula (A) are shown in formulas (B)-(E) below:
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00016
  • where o, X, p, R5, and R6, are as defined above;
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00017
  • where n is an integer from 1 to 10 and R5 is as defined above;
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00018
  • where n is an integer from 1 from 10 and R5 is as defined above;
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00019
  • where o, x, p, and R5 are as defined above.
  • In a preferred embodiment of the invention, Y is —NH2.
  • In another preferred embodiment, R2 is hydrogen.
  • In another preferred embodiment, R1 is hydrogen.
  • In another preferred embodiment, X is chlorine.
  • In another preferred embodiment, R3 is hydrogen.
  • In another preferred embodiment, RL is hydrogen.
  • In another preferred embodiment, o is 4.
  • In another preferred embodiment, p is 0.
  • In another preferred embodiment, the sum of o and p is 4.
  • In another preferred embodiment, x represents a single bond.
  • In another preferred embodiment, R6 is hydrogen.
  • In another preferred embodiment, at most one Q is a nitrogen atom.
  • In another preferred embodiment, no Q is a nitrogen atom.
  • In a preferred embodiment of the present invention:
  • X is halogen;
  • Y is —N(R7)2;
  • R1 is hydrogen or C1-C3 alkyl;
  • R2 is —R7, —OR7, CH2OR7, or —CO2R7;
  • R3 is a group represented by formula (A); and
  • R4 is hydrogen, a group represented by formula (A), or lower alkyl;
  • In another preferred embodiment of the present invention:
  • X is chloro or bromo;
  • Y is —N(R7)2;
  • R is hydrogen or C1-C3 alkyl;
  • at most three R6 are other than hydrogen as described above;
  • at most three RL are other than hydrogen as described above; and
  • at most 2 Q are nitrogen atoms.
  • In another preferred embodiment of the present invention:
  • Y is —NH2;
  • In another preferred embodiment of the present invention:
  • R4 is hydrogen;
  • at most one L is other than hydrogen as described above;
  • at most two R6 are other than hydrogen as described above; and
  • at most 1 Q is a nitrogen atom.
  • The compounds of formula (I) may be prepared and used as the free base. Alternatively, the compounds may be prepared and used as a pharmaceutically acceptable salt. Pharmaceutically acceptable salts are salts that retain or enhance the desired biological activity of the parent compound and do not impart undesired toxicological effects. Examples of such salts are (a) acid addition salts formed with inorganic acids, for example, hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, phosphoric acid, nitric acid and the like; (b) salts formed with organic acids such as, for example, acetic acid, oxalic acid, tartaric acid, succinic acid, maleic acid, fumaric acid, gluconic acid, citric acid, malic acid, ascorbic acid, benzoic acid, tannic acid, palmitic acid, alginic acid, polyglutamic acid, naphthalenesulfonic acid, methanesulfonic acid, p-toluenesulfonic acid, naphthalenedisulfonic acid, polygalacturonic acid, malonic acid, sulfosalicylic acid, glycolic acid, 2-hydroxy-3-naphthoate, pamoate, salicylic acid, stearic acid, phthalic acid, mandelic acid, lactic acid and the like; and (c) salts formed from elemental anions for example, chlorine, bromine, and iodine.
  • It is to be noted that all enantiomers, diastereomers, and racemic mixtures of compounds within the scope of formula (I) are embraced by the present invention. All mixtures of such enantiomers and diastereomers are within the scope of the present invention.
  • Without being limited to any particular theory, it is believed that the compounds of formula (I) function in vivo as sodium channel blockers. By blocking epithelial sodium channels present in mucosal surfaces the compounds of formula (I) reduce the absorption of water by the mucosal surfaces. This effect increases the volume of protective liquids on mucosal surfaces, rebalances the system, and thus treats disease.
  • The present invention also provides methods of treatment that take advantage of the properties of the compounds of formula (I) discussed above. Thus, subjects that may be treated by the methods of the present invention include, but are not limited to, patients afflicted with cystic fibrosis, primary ciliary dyskinesia, chronic bronchitis, chronic obstructive airway disease, artificially ventilated patients, patients with acute pneumonia, etc.
  • The present invention may be used to obtain a sputum sample from a patient by administering the active compounds to at least one lung of a patient, and then inducing or collecting a sputum sample from that patient. Typically, the invention will be administered to respiratory mucosal surfaces via aerosol (liquid or dry powders) or lavage.
  • Subjects that may be treated by the method of the present invention also include patients being administered supplemental oxygen nasally (a regimen that tends to dry the airway surfaces); patients afflicted with an allergic disease or response (e.g., an allergic response to pollen, dust, animal hair or particles, insects or insect particles, etc.) that affects nasal airway surfaces; patients afflicted with a bacterial infection e.g., staphylococcus infections such as Staphylococcus aureus infections, Hemophilus influenza infections, Streptococcus pneumoniae infections, Pseudomonas aeuriginosa infections, etc.) of the nasal airway surfaces; patients afflicted with an inflammatory disease that affects nasal airway surfaces; or patients afflicted with sinusitis (wherein the active agent or agents are administered to promote drainage of congested mucous secretions in the sinuses by administering an amount effective to promote drainage of congested fluid in the sinuses), or combined, Rhinosinusitis. The invention may be administered to rhino-sinal surfaces by topical delivery, including aerosols and drops.
  • The present invention may be used to hydrate mucosal surfaces other than airway surfaces. Such other mucosal surfaces include gastrointestinal surfaces, oral surfaces, genito-urethral surfaces, ocular surfaces or surfaces of the eye, the inner ear and the middle ear. For example, the active compounds of the present invention may be administered by any suitable means, including locally/topically, orally, or rectally, in an effective amount.
  • The compounds of the present invention are also useful for treating a variety of functions relating to the cardiovascular system. Thus, the compounds of the present invention are useful for use as antihypertensive agents. The compounds may also be used to reduce blood pressure and to treat edema. In addition, the compounds of the present invention are also useful for promoting diuresis, natriuresis, and saluresis. The compounds may be used alone or in combination with beta blockers, ACE inhibitors, HMGCoA reductase inhibitors, calcium channel blockers and other cardiovascular agents to treat hypertension, congestive heart failure and reduce cardiovascular mortality.
  • The present invention is concerned primarily with the treatment of human subjects, but may also be employed for the treatment of other mammalian subjects, such as dogs and cats, for veterinary purposes.
  • As discussed above, the compounds used to prepare the compositions of the present invention may be in the form of a pharmaceutically acceptable free base. Because the free base of the compound is generally less soluble in aqueous solutions than the salt, free base compositions are employed to provide more sustained release of active agent to the lungs. An active agent present in the lungs in particulate form which has not dissolved into solution is not available to induce a physiological response, but serves as a depot of bioavailable drug which gradually dissolves into solution.
  • Another aspect of the present invention is a pharmaceutical composition, comprising a compound of formula (I) in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier (e.g., an aqueous carrier solution). In general, the compound of formula (I) is included in the composition in an amount effective to inhibit the reabsorption of water by mucosal surfaces.
  • The compounds of the present invention may also be used in conjunction with a P2Y2 receptor agonist or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof (also sometimes referred to as an “active agent” herein). The composition may further comprise a P2Y2 receptor agonist or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof (also sometimes referred to as an “active agent” herein). The P2Y2 receptor agonist is typically included in an amount effective to stimulate chloride and water secretion by airway surfaces, particularly nasal airway surfaces. Suitable P2Y2 receptor agonists are described in columns 9-10 of U.S. Pat. No. 6,264,975, U.S. Pat. No. 5,656,256, and U.S. Pat. No. 5,292,498, each of which is incorporated herein by reference.
  • Bronchodiloators can also be used in combination with compounds of the present invention. These bronchodilators include, but are not limited to, β-adrenergic agonists including but not limited to epinephrine, isoproterenol, fenoterol, albutereol, terbutalin, pirbuterol, bitolterol, metaproterenol, iosetharine, salmeterol xinafoate, as well as anticholinergic agents including but not limited to ipratropium bromide, as well as compounds such as theophylline and aminophylline. These compounds may be administered in accordance with known techniques, either prior to or concurrently with the active compounds described herein.
  • Another aspect of the present invention is a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising an active compound as described above in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier (e.g., an aqueous carrier solution). In general, the active compound is included in the composition in an amount effective to treat mucosal surfaces, such as inhibiting the reabsorption of water by mucosal surfaces, including airway and other surfaces.
  • The active compounds disclosed herein may be administered to mucosal surfaces by any suitable means, including topically, orally, rectally, vaginally, ocularly and dermally, etc. For example, for the treatment of constipation, the active compounds may be administered orally or rectally to the gastrointestinal mucosal surface. The active compound may be combined with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier in any suitable form, such as sterile physiological or dilute saline or topical solution, as a droplet, tablet or the like for oral administration, as a suppository for rectal or genito-urethral administration, etc. Excipients may be included in the formulation to enhance the solubility of the active compounds, as desired.
  • The active compounds disclosed herein may be administered to the airway surfaces of a patient by any suitable means, including as a spray, mist, or droplets of the active compounds in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier such as physiological or dilute saline solutions or distilled water. For example, the active compounds may be prepared as formulations and administered as described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,789,391 to Jacobus, the disclosure of which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety.
  • Solid or liquid particulate active agents prepared for practicing the present invention could, as noted above, include particles of respirable or non-respirable size; that is, for respirable particles, particles of a size sufficiently small to pass through the mouth and larynx upon inhalation and into the bronchi and alveoli of the lungs, and for non-respirable particles, particles sufficiently large to be retained in the nasal airway passages rather than pass through the larynx and into the bronchi and alveoli of the lungs. In general, particles ranging from about 1 to 5 microns in size (more particularly, less than about 4.7 microns in size) are respirable. Particles of non-respirable size are greater than about 5 microns in size, up to the size of visible droplets. Thus, for nasal administration, a particle size in the range of 10-500 μm may be used to ensure retention in the nasal cavity.
  • In the manufacture of a formulation according to the invention, active agents or the physiologically acceptable salts or free bases thereof are typically admixed with, inter alia, an acceptable carrier. Of course, the carrier must be compatible with any other ingredients in the formulation and must not be deleterious to the patient. The carrier must be solid or liquid, or both, and is preferably formulated with the compound as a unit-dose formulation, for example, a capsule, that may contain 0.5% to 99% by weight of the active compound. One or more active compounds may be incorporated in the formulations of the invention, which formulations may be prepared by any of the well-known techniques of pharmacy consisting essentially of admixing the components.
  • Compositions containing respirable or non-respirable dry particles of micronized active agent may be prepared by grinding the dry active agent with a mortar and pestle, and then passing the micronized composition through a 400 mesh screen to break up or separate out large agglomerates.
  • The particulate active agent composition may optionally contain a dispersant which serves to facilitate the formulation of an aerosol. A suitable dispersant is lactose, which may be blended with the active agent in any suitable ratio (e.g., a 1 to 1 ratio by weight).
  • Active compounds disclosed herein may be administered to airway surfaces including the nasal passages, sinuses and lungs of a subject by a suitable means know in the art, such as by nose drops, mists, etc. In one embodiment of the invention, the active compounds of the present invention and administered by transbronchoscopic lavage. In a preferred embodiment of the invention, the active compounds of the present invention are deposited on lung airway surfaces by administering an aerosol suspension of respirable particles comprised of the active compound, which the subject inhales. The respirable particles may be liquid or solid. Numerous inhalers for administering aerosol particles to the lungs of a subject are known.
  • Inhalers such as those developed by Inhale Therapeutic Systems, Palo Alto, Calif., USA, may be employed, including but not limited to those disclosed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,740,794; 5,654,007; 5,458,135; 5,775,320; and 5,785,049, each of which is incorporated herein by reference. The Applicant specifically intends that the disclosures of all patent references cited herein be incorporated by reference herein in their entirety. Inhalers such as those developed by Dura Pharmaceuticals, Inc., San Diego, Calif., USA, may also be employed, including but not limited to those disclosed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,622,166; 5,577,497; 5,645,051; and 5,492,112, each of which is incorporated herein by reference. Additionally, inhalers such as those developed by Aradigm Corp., Hayward, Calif., USA, may be employed, including but not limited to those disclosed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,826,570; 5,813,397; 5,819,726; and 5,655,516, each of which is incorporated herein by reference. These apparatuses are particularly suitable as dry particle inhalers.
  • Aerosols of liquid particles comprising the active compound may be produced by any suitable means, such as with a pressure-driven aerosol nebulizer or an ultrasonic nebulizer. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,501,729, which is incorporated herein by reference. Nebulizers are commercially available devices which transform solutions or suspensions of the active ingredient into a therapeutic aerosol mist either by means of acceleration of compressed gas, typically air or oxygen, through a narrow venturi orifice or by means of ultrasonic agitation. Suitable formulations for use in nebulizers consist of the active ingredient in a liquid carrier, the active ingredient comprising up to 40% w/w of the formulation, but preferably less than 20% w/w. The carrier is typically water (and most preferably sterile, pyrogen-free water) or dilute aqueous alcoholic solution. Perfluorocarbon carriers may also be used. Optional additives include preservatives if the formulation is not made sterile, for example, methyl hydroxybenzoate, antioxidants, flavoring agents, volatile oils, buffering agents and surfactants.
  • Aerosols of solid particles comprising the active compound may likewise be produced with any solid particulate medicament aerosol generator. Aerosol generators for administering solid particulate medicaments to a subject produce particles which are respirable, as explained above, and generate a volume of aerosol containing predetermined metered dose of medicament at a rate suitable for human administration. One illustrative type of solid particulate aerosol generator is an insufflator. Suitable formulations for administration by insufflation include finely comminuted powders which may be delivered by means of an insufflator or taken into the nasal cavity in the manner of a snuff. In the insufflator, the powder (e.g., a metered dose thereof effective to carry out the treatments described herein) is contained in capsules or cartridges, typically made of gelatin or plastic, which are either pierced or opened in situ and the powder delivered by air drawn through the device upon inhalation or by means of a manually-operated pump. The powder employed in the insufflator consists either solely of the active ingredient or of powder blend comprising the active ingredient, a suitable powder diluent, such as lactose, and an optional surfactant. The active ingredient typically comprises of 0.1 to 100% w/w of the formulation. A second type of illustrative aerosol generator comprises a metered dose inhaler. Metered dose inhalers are pressurized aerosol dispensers, typically containing a suspension or solution formulation of active ingredient in a liquified propellant. During use, these devices discharge the formulation through a valve adapted to deliver a metered volume, typically from 10 to 150 μl, to produce a fine particle spray containing the active ingredient. Suitable propellants include certain chlorofluorocarbon compounds, for example, dichlorodifluoromethane, trichlorofluoromethane, dichlorotetrafluoroethane and mixtures thereof. The formulation may additionally contain one of more co-solvents, for example, ethanol, surfactants, such as oleic acid or sorbitan trioleate, antioxidants and suitable flavoring agents.
  • The aerosol, whether formed from solid or liquid particles, may be produced by the aerosol generator at a rate of from about 10 to 150 liters per minute, more preferable from 30 to 150 liters per minute, and most preferably about 60 liters per minute. Aerosols containing greater amounts of medicament may be administered more rapidly.
  • The dosage of the active compounds disclosed herein will vary depending on the condition being treated and the state of the subject, but generally may be from about 0.01, 0.03, 0.05, 0.1 to 1, 5, 10 or 20 mg of the pharmaceutic agent, deposited on the airway surfaces. The daily dose may be divided among one or multiple unit dose administrations. The goal is to achieve a concentration of the pharmaceutic agents on lung airway surfaces of between 10−9-104 M.
  • In another embodiment, they are administered by administering an aerosol suspension of respirable or non-respirable particles (preferably non-respirable particles) comprised of active compound, which the subject inhales through the nose. The respirable or non-respirable particles may be liquid or solid. The quantity of active agent included may be an amount of sufficient to achieve dissolved concentrations of active agent on the airway surfaces of the subject of from about 10−9, 10−8, or 10−7 to about 10−3, 10−2, 10−1 moles/liter, and more preferably from about 10−9 to about 10−4 moles/liter.
  • The dosage of active compound will vary depending on the condition being treated and the state of the subject, but generally may be an amount sufficient to achieve dissolved concentrations of active compound on the nasal airway surfaces of the subject from about 10−9, 10−8, 10−7 to about 10−3, 10−2, or 10−1 moles/liter, and more preferably from about 10−7 to about 10−4 moles/liter. Depending upon the solubility of the particular formulation of active compound administered, the daily dose may be divided among one or several unit dose administrations. The daily dose by weight may range from about 0.01, 0.03, 0.1, 0.5 or 1.0 to 10 or 20 milligrams of active agent particles for a human subject, depending upon the age and condition of the subject. A currently preferred unit dose is about 0.5 milligrams of active agent given at a regimen of 2-10 administrations per day. The dosage may be provided as a prepackaged unit by any suitable means (e.g., encapsulating a gelatin capsule).
  • In one embodiment of the invention, the particulate active agent composition may contain both a free base of active agent and a pharmaceutically acceptable salt to provide both early release and sustained release of active agent for dissolution into the mucus secretions of the nose. Such a composition serves to provide both early relief to the patient, and sustained relief over time. Sustained relief, by decreasing the number of daily administrations required, is expected to increase patient compliance with the course of active agent treatments.
  • Pharmaceutical formulations suitable for airway administration include formulations of solutions, emulsions, suspensions and extracts. See generally, J. Nairn, Solutions, Emulsions, Suspensions and Extracts, in Remington: The Science and Practice of Pharmacy, chap. 86 (19th ed. 1995), incorporated herein by reference. Pharmaceutical formulations suitable for nasal administration may be prepared as described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,389,393 to Schor; 5,707,644 to Illum; 4,294,829 to Suzuki; and 4,835,142 to Suzuki, the disclosures of which are incorporated by reference herein in their entirety.
  • Mists or aerosols of liquid particles comprising the active compound may be produced by any suitable means, such as by a simple nasal spray with the active agent in an aqueous pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, such as a sterile saline solution or sterile water. Administration may be with a pressure-driven aerosol nebulizer or an ultrasonic nebulizer. See e.g. U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,501,729 and 5,656,256, both of which are incorporated herein by reference. Suitable formulations for use in a nasal droplet or spray bottle or in nebulizers consist of the active ingredient in a liquid carrier, the active ingredient comprising up to 40% w/w of the formulation, but preferably less than 20% w/w. Typically the carrier is water (and most preferably sterile, pyrogen-free water) or dilute aqueous alcoholic solution, preferably made in a 0.12% to 0.8% solution of sodium chloride. Optional additives include preservatives if the formulation is not made sterile, for example, methyl hydroxybenzoate, antioxidants, flavoring agents, volatile oils, buffering agents, osmotically active agents (e.g. mannitol, xylitol, erythritol) and surfactants.
  • Compositions containing respirable or non-respirable dry particles of micronized active agent may be prepared by grinding the dry active agent with a mortar and pestle, and then passing the micronized composition through a 400 mesh screen to break up or separate out large agglomerates.
  • The particulate composition may optionally contain a dispersant which serves to facilitate the formation of an aerosol. A suitable dispersant is lactose, which may be blended with the active agent in any suitable ratio (e.g., a 1 to 1 ratio by weight).
  • The compounds of formula (I) may be synthesized according to procedures known in the art. A representative synthetic procedure is shown in the scheme below:
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00020
  • These procedures are described in, for example, E. J. Cragoe, “The Synthesis of Amiloride and Its Analogs” (Chapter 3) in Amiloride and Its Analogs, pp. 25-36, incorporated herein by reference. Other methods of preparing the compounds are described in, for example, U.S. Pat. No. 3,313,813, incorporated herein by reference. See in particular Methods A, B, C, and D described in U.S. Pat. No. 3,313,813. Several assays may be used to characterize the compounds of the present invention. Representative assays are discussed below.
  • In Vitro Measure of Sodium Channel Blocking Activity and Reversibility
  • One assay used to assess mechanism of action and/or potency of the compounds of the present invention involves the determination of lumenal drug inhibition of airway epithelial sodium currents measured under short circuit current (ISC) using airway epithelial monolayers mounted in Using chambers. Cells obtained from freshly excised human, dog, sheep or rodent airways are seeded onto porous 0.4 micron Snapwell™ Inserts (CoStar), cultured at air-liquid interface (ALI) conditions in hormonally defined media, and assayed for sodium transport activity (ISC) while bathed in Krebs Bicarbonate Ringer (KBR) in Using chambers. All test drug additions are to the lumenal bath with half-log dose addition protocols (from 1×10−11 M to 3×10−5 M), and the cumulative change in ISC (inhibition) recorded. All drugs are prepared in dimethyl sulfoxide as stock solutions at a concentration of 1×10−2 M and stored at −20° C. Eight preparations are typically run in parallel; two preparations per run incorporate amiloride and/or benzamil as positive controls. After the maximal concentration (5×10−5 M) is administered, the lumenal bath is exchanged three times with fresh drug-free KBR solution, and the resultant ISC measured after each wash for approximately 5 minutes in duration. Reversibility is defined as the percent return to the baseline value for sodium current after the third wash. All data from the voltage clamps are collected via a computer interface and analyzed off-line.
  • Dose-effect relationships for all compounds are considered and analyzed by the Prism 3.0 program. IC50 values, maximal effective concentrations, and reversibility are calculated and compared to amiloride and benzamil as positive controls.
  • Pharmacological Assays of Absorption (1) Apical Disappearance Assay
  • Bronchial cells (dog, human, sheep, or rodent cells) are seeded at a density of 0.25×106/cm2 on a porous Transwell-Col collagen-coated membrane with a growth area of 1.13 cm2 grown at an air-liquid interface in hormonally defined media that promotes a polarized epithelium. From 12 to 20 days after development of an air-liquid interface (ALI) the cultures are expected to be >90% ciliated, and mucins will accumulate on the cells. To ensure the integrity of primary airway epithelial cell preparations, the transepithelial resistance (Rt) and transepithelial potential differences (PD), which are indicators of the integrity of polarized nature of the culture, are measured. Human cell systems are preferred for studies of rates of absorption from apical surfaces. The disappearance assay is conducted under conditions that mimic the “thin” films in vivo (˜25 μl) and is initiated by adding experimental sodium channel blockers or positive controls (amiloride, benzamil, phenamil) to the apical surface at an initial concentration of 10 μM. A series of samples (5 μl volume per sample) is collected at various time points, including 0, 5, 20, 40, 90 and 240 minutes. Concentrations are determined by measuring intrinsic fluorescence of each sodium channel blocker using a Fluorocount Microplate Fluorometer or HPLC. Quantitative analysis employs a standard curve generated from authentic reference standard materials of known concentration and purity. Data analysis of the rate of disappearance is performed using nonlinear regression, one phase exponential decay (Prism V 3.0).
  • 2. Confocal Microscopy Assay of Amiloride Congener Uptake
  • Virtually all amiloride-like molecules fluoresce in the ultraviolet range. This property of these molecules may be used to directly measure cellular update using x-z confocal microscopy. Equimolar concentrations of experimental compounds and positive controls including amiloride and compounds that demonstrate rapid uptake into the cellular compartment (benzamil and phenamil) are placed on the apical surface of airway cultures on the stage of the confocal microscope. Serial x-z images are obtained with time and the magnitude of fluorescence accumulating in the cellular compartment is quantitated and plotted as a change in fluorescence versus time.
  • 3. In vitro Assays of Compound Metabolism
  • Airway epithelial cells have the capacity to metabolize drugs during the process of transepithelial absorption. Further, although less likely, it is possible that drugs can be metabolized on airway epithelial surfaces by specific ectoenzyme activities. Perhaps more likely as an ecto-surface event, compounds may be metabolized by the infected secretions that occupy the airway lumens of patients with lung disease, e.g. cystic fibrosis. Thus, a series of assays is performed to characterize the compound metabolism that results from the interaction of test compounds with human airway epithelia and/or human airway epithelial lumenal products.
  • In the first series of assays, the interaction of test compounds in KBR as an “ASL” stimulant are applied to the apical surface of human airway epithelial cells grown in the T-Col insert system. For most compounds, metabolism (generation of new species) is tested for using high performance liquid chromatography (HPLC) to resolve chemical species and the endogenous fluorescence properties of these compounds to estimate the relative quantities of test compound and novel metabolites. For a typical assay, a test solution (25 μl KBR, containing 10 μM test compound) is placed on the epithelial lumenal surface. Sequential 5 to 10 μl samples are obtained from the lumenal and serosal compartments for HPLC analysis of (1) the mass of test compound permeating from the lumenal to serosal bath and (2) the potential formation of metabolites from the parent compound. In instances where the fluorescence properties of the test molecule are not adequate for such characterizations, radiolabeled compounds are used for these assays. From the HPLC data, the rate of disappearance and/or formation of novel metabolite compounds on the lumenal surface and the appearance of test compound and/or novel metabolite in the basolateral solution is quantitated. The data relating the chromatographic mobility of potential novel metabolites with reference to the parent compound are also quantitated.
  • To analyze the potential metabolism of test compounds by CF sputum, a “representative” mixture of expectorated CF sputum obtained from 10 CF patients (under IRB approval) has been collected. The sputum has been be solubilized in a 1:5 mixture of KBR solution with vigorous vortexing, following which the mixture was split into a “neat” sputum aliquot and an aliquot subjected to ultracentrifugation so that a “supernatant” aliquot was obtained (neat=cellular; supernatant=liquid phase). Typical studies of compound metabolism by CF sputum involve the addition of known masses of test compound to “neat” CF sputum and aliquots of CF sputum “supernatant” incubated at 37° C., followed by sequential sampling of aliquots from each sputum type for characterization of compound stability/metabolism by HPLC analysis as described above. As above, analysis of compound disappearance, rates of formation of novel metabolities, and HPLC mobilities of novel metabolites are then performed.
  • 4. Pharmacological Effects and Mechanism of Action of the Drug in Animals
  • The effect of compounds for enhancing mucociliary clearance (MCC) can be measured using an in vivo model described by Sabater et al., Journal of Applied Physiology, 1999, pp. 2191-2196, incorporated herein by reference.
  • EXAMPLES
  • Having generally described this invention, a further understanding can be obtained by reference to certain specific examples which are provided herein for purposes of illustration only and are not intended to be limiting unless otherwise specified.
  • Preparation of Sodium Channel Blockers
  • Materials and methods. All reagents and solvents were purchased from Aldrich Chemical Corp. and used without further purification. NMR spectra were obtained on either a Bruker WM 360 (1H NMR at 360 MHz and 13C NMR at 90 MHz) or a Bruker AC 300 (1H NMR at 300 MHz and 13C NMR at 75 MHz). Flash chromatography was performed on a Flash Elute™ system from Elution Solution (PO Box 5147, Charlottesville, Va. 22905) charged with a 90 g silica gel cartridge (40M FSO-0110-040155, 32-63 μm) at 20 psi (N2). GC-analysis was performed on a Shimadzu GC-17 equipped with a Heliflex Capillary Column (Alltech); Phase: AT-1, Length: 10 meters, ID: 0.53 mm, Film: 0.25 micrometers. GC Parameters: Injector at 320° C., Detector at 320° C., FID gas flow: H2 at 40 ml/min., Air at 400 ml/min. Carrier gas: Split Ratio 16:1, N2 flow at 15 ml/min., N2 velocity at 18 cm/sec. The temperature program is 70° C. for 0-3 min, 70-300° C. from 3-10 min, 300° C. from 10-15 min.
  • HPLC analysis was performed on a Gilson 322 Pump, detector UV/is-156 at 360 nm, equipped with a Microsorb MV C8 column, 100 A, 25 cm. Mobile phase: A=acetonitrile with 0.1% TFA, B=water with 0.1% TFA. Gradient program: 95:5 B:A for 1 min, then to 20:80 B:A over 7 min, then to 100% A over 1 min, followed by washout with 100% A for 11 min, flow rate: 1 ml/min.
  • Example 1 4-(4-Carboxymethylphenyl)butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (9)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00021
  • Methanesulfonic acid 4-(4-carboxymethylphenyl)butyl ester (6)
  • Compound 6 was prepared according to the published procedure1. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.75 (m, 4H), 2.78 (m, 2H), 3.12 (s, 3H), 3.88 (s, 3H), 4.22 (m, 2H), 7.28 (d, 2H), 7.98 (d, 2H)
  • 4-(4-Carboxymethylphenyl)butylazide (7). Typical procedure C
  • Compound 6 (6 g, 0.02 mol) was dissolved in 80 ml of dry DMF then sodium azide (1.8 g, 0.027 mol) was added. The suspension was stirred at 80° C. (oil bath) for 3 h. The solvent was then removed at reduced pressure and the residual oil was treated with CH2Cl2 (100 mL). The resulting solution was washed with water (2×100 mL), brine and dried over magnesium sulfate. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure then the residue was redissolved in a 1:1 mixture of ethyl acetate/hexanes (200 mL) and passed through a pad of silica gel. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure to give 4.1 g (85%) of 7 as clear oil. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.68 (m, 4H), 2.22 (t, 2H), 3.29 (t, 3H), 3.92 (s, 3H), 7.28 (d, 2H), 7.98 (d, 2H).
  • 4-(4-Carboxymethylphenyl)butylamine (8)
  • Azide 7 (1.7 g, 7.2 mmol) and triphenylphosphine (1.9 g, 7.2 mmol) were dissolved in a 10% solution of water in THF (66 mL) and stirred overnight at 25° C. Then more triphenylphosphine (0.8 g, 3 mmol) was added and the heating was continued at 60° C. (oil bath) for 6 h. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was treated with 2M HCl (100 mL) and extracted with ethyl acetate (2×50 mL). The water fraction was collected and ammonium hydroxide was added until the pH reached approximately 13. The mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate (2×100 mL) then the organic fraction was washed with brine, water and dried with sodium sulfate. Ethyl acetate was removed under reduced pressure to give 0.8 g (53%) of amine 8.
  • 4-(4-Carboxymethylphenyl)butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (9). Typical procedure D.
  • 1-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl-2-methyl-pseudothiourea hydroiodide (0.2 g, 0.5 mmol) was added to a solution of 8 (0.7 g, 3.4 mmol) in THF (20 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at reflux for 6 h, then the solvent was evaporated and the resultant oil was treated with 10% HCl (15 mL). The precipitate was isolated and crystallized twice from ethanol to give 9 (53 mg, 25%) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.59 (br s, 4H), 2.71 (m, 2H), 3.83 (s, 3H), 7.40 (d, 2H), 7.48 (br s, 2H), 7.80 (d, 2H), 8.92 (br s, 2H), 9.00 (br s, 1H), 9.48 (br s, 2H), 10.55 (s, 1H). APCI MS m/z=420 [C18H22ClN7O3+H]+.
  • Example 2 4-(4-Sulfatephenyl)butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide (10)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00022
  • 4-(4-Sulfatephenyl)butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide (10)
  • 4-(4-Hydroxyphenyl)butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride 5 (0.2 g, 0.5 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of dry pyridine and pyridine sulfurtrioxide (450 mg, 2.5 mmol) was added. The reaction mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature and the precipitate that formed was isolated by filtration and washed with ethyl acetate (2×25 mL) to give crude 10 (180 mg, 39%, purity 87% by HPLC). An aliquot of the crude 10 (67 mg) was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, 6:3:0.1 methylene chloride/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) to give 10 as a yellow solid (9.3 mg, 4% based on starting 5). 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.59 (br s, 4H), 2.58 (m, 2H), 3.28 (m, 2H), 7.08 (s, 4H), 7.1-7.9 (m, 6H). ESI MS m/z=456 [C16H20ClN7O5S—H].
  • Example 3 4-[4-(2,3-Dihydroxypropyloxyl)phenyl] butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (33)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00023
  • N-Cbz-4-(4-hydroxyphenyl)butylamine (29)
  • To vigorously stirred suspension of 4 (10.5 g, 0.043 mol) in THF (approx. 150 mL) was added sodium hydrogencarbonate (11 g, 0.13 mol) and then water until a clear solution was obtained (approx. 50 mL). The reaction mixture was cooled to 0° C. then benzyl chloroformate (10 mL, 0.07 mol) was added and the reaction was stirred overnight. The solvent was removed at reduced pressure then ethyl acetate (approx. 100 mL) was added to the residue. The organics were washed with HCl (2 M solution, 2×30 mL), water (2×50 mL), and dried over sodium sulfate. The solvent was removed and the residue was purified by column chromatography (silica gel, 1:1 ethyl acetate/hexanes) to provide 29 (10 g, 85%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.55 (br s, 4H), 2.53 (m, 2H), 3.19 (m, 2H), 5.05 (s, 2H), 5.83 (s, 1H), 6.73 (d, 2H), 7.00 (d, 2H), 7.38 (m, 5H).
  • N-Cbz-4-(4-allyloxyphenyl)butylamine (30)
  • Potassium tert-butoxide (1.7 g, 15.2 mmol) and 18-crown-6 (0.1 g, 0.3 mmol) were added to a solution of 29 (4.3 g, 14.3 mmol) in dry MeCN (80 mL) and the mixture was stirred for 20 min at room temperature. After this time, allyl bromide (1.2 mL, 14.3 mmol) in MeCN (10 mL) was added. The reaction mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature, then the precipitate was filtered off and washed with ethyl acetate. The organic fractions were combined, the solvent was removed at reduced pressure and the residue was purified twice by flash chromatography (silica gel, 1:1 ethyl acetate/hexanes) to provide compound 30 (3.4 g, 71%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.55 (m, 4H), 2.54 (t, 2H), 3.20 (m, 2H), 4.50 (d, 2H), 5.08 (s, 2H), 5.28 (d, 1H), 5.40 (d, 1H), 6.06 (m, 1H), 6.82 (d, 2H), 7.05 (d, 2H), 7.33 (s, 5H)
  • N-Cbz-4-[(2,3-dihydroxypropyloxy)phenyl]butylamine (31)
  • A solution of osmium tetroxide (50 mg, 0.2 mmol) in tert-butanol (8 mL) was added to a solution of 4-methylmorpholine N-oxide monohydrate (1.2 g, 9.1 mmol) in 100 mL (1:1) acetone/water solution and the mixture was stirred for 10 min at room temperature. After this time, 30 (3.1 g, 9.0 mmol) was added in 50 mL (1:1) acetone/water solution. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight, then NaHSO3 (0.5 g) was added and the stirring was continued for 15 min. The acetone was evaporated and the pH was adjusted to 5.5 by the addition of 2NHCl then the mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate. The organic fraction was isolated, dried with sodium sulfate, and filtered through silica gel. Compound 31 (2.1 g, 62%) was isolated as a white solid after removing the solvent and drying under vacuum. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.48 (m, 2H), 1.50 (m, 2H), 2,46 (m, 2H), 3.00 (m, 2H), 3.43 (m, 2H), 3.80 (m, 2H), 3.93 (t, 1H), 4.66 (d, 1H), 4.99 (s, 2H), 6.82 (d, 2H), 7.07 (d, 2H), 7.26 (s, 1H), 7.33 (s, 5H).
  • 4-[(2,3-Dihydroxypropyloxy)phenyl]butylamine (32)
  • Cbz-protected amine 31 (2.1 g, 5.6 mmol) was dissolved in methanol (50 mL) and Pd/C (0.46 g, 5% wet) was added in methanol (20 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred for 3 h at 1 atmosphere of hydrogen, then the solution was filtered through a pad of silica gel. The solvent was then evaporated to give free amine 32 (0.9 g, 66%). 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.37 (m, 2H), 1.50 (m, 2H), 2.92 (m, 1H), 3.22-4.05 (br s, 4H), 3.43 (m, 2H), 3.93 (m, 1H), 6.82 (d, 2H), 7.07 (d, 2H).
  • 4-[4-(2,3-Dihydroxypropyloxyl)phenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (33). (General Procedure Z)
  • 1-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl-2-methyl-pseudothiourea hydroiodide (1.5 g, 3.8 mmol) was added to a solution of 32 (0.9 g, 3.7 mmol) in a mixture of THF (50 mL) and diisopropylethylamine (2 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at reflux (66° C.) for 4 h. After this time, the reaction mixture was cooled to room temperature and the formed precipitate was isolated as a yellow solid. The obtained solid was washed with 5% HCl, water, and dried under vacuum to give 33 (0.88 g) as a yellow solid. The mother liquor was evaporated and the residue was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, 5:1:05 chloroform/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide). The isolated free amino compound was treated with 5% HCl to give an additional portion of 33 (0.12 g). The total yield of 33 was 53%. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.56 (m, 4H), 2,56 (br s, 2H), 3.31 (m, 2H), 3.42 (m, 2H), 3.82 (m, 2H), 3.93 (m, 2H), 4.32 (br s, 4H), 6.84 (d, 2H), 7.10 (d, 2H), 7.45 (br s, 2H), 8.81 (br s, 1H), 8.94 (br s, 1H), 9.25 (br s, 1H), 10.52 (s, 1H). APCI MS m/z=452 [C19H26ClN7O4+H]+.
  • Example 4 Substituted 3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide amidines (Cont) Alternate Preparation of Amine 32 4-(4-Methoxyphenyl)butyramide (117)
  • 4-(4-Methoxyphenyl) butyric acid (1) (450 g, 2.32 mole) was combined with dry THF (4 L) and 4-methylmorpholine (268 mL, 2.43 mole) in a 12 L three neck flask with mechanical stirring, an ice-methanol cooling bath and nitrogen atmosphere. Small pieces of dry ice were used to bring the bath temperature below −20° C. Isobutyl chloroformate was added at a rate so as not to exceed an internal temperature of −10° C. After stirring for 30 min. at −10 to −20° C., a 4.7 M solution of ammonia in methanol (990 mL, 4.64 mole) was added in one portion. During the addition, the reaction temperature rose to 0° C. The reaction was allowed to stir for 30 min. and then allowed to stand overnight. The product mixture was transferred to a 22 L separatory funnel with ethyl acetate (6 L), and 10% sodium chloride solution (1.5 L). The layers were separated and the organic solution was washed with 10% sodium chloride solution (4×1 L) and then brine (3×500 mL). The organic layer was dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, evaporated and placed under high vacuum overnight. This afforded 432 g (97%) of the pure amide (117) as an off white solid.
  • 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.81-1.93 (m, 2H), 2.20 (t, J=7.7 Hz, 2H), 2.57 (t, J=7.7 Hz, 2H), 3.74 (s, 3H), 6.82 (d, J=8.7 Hz), 7.09 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 1H). CI MS m/z=194 [C11H15NO2+H]+.
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00024
  • 4-(4-Hydroxyphenyl)butylamine hydrobromide (4)
  • 4-(4-Methoxyphenyl)butyramide (117) (200 g, 1.0 mole) and THF (300 mL) were combined in a 12 L three neck flask which was equipped with a heating mantle, an internal thermometer and a reflux condenser. The suspension was slowly mechanically stirred while a 1 M borane-THF complex (1 L, 1 mole) was dripped in via a pressure equalizing addition funnel over 20 min. Another 2.2 L (2.2 mole) of 1 M borane-THF complex was dripped in over 20 min. The reaction temperature rose to 45° C. during the addition. The reaction was stirred and heated to reflux over 1 h, at reflux for 2 h and then allowed to cool for 2 h. Methanol (500 mL) was slowly and cautiously dripped into the reaction. Copious H2 evolution was observed. The reaction was heated at reflux for 2 h and allowed to cool overnight. The reaction was evaporated and then co-evaporated with toluene (500 mL) to a thick oil. 48% HBr (3 L) was slowly and cautiously added to the reaction. Bubbling and foaming was observed during this addition which was exothermic. After the addition, the reaction became stirrable, and was stirred at reflux for 7 h. The reaction was allowed to cool with stirring overnight. The reaction was stirred with ice bath cooling and then suction filtered to collect an off white solid. The solid was co-evaporated with toluene/methanol (1:1) and then dried under vacuum at 60° C. overnight. This afforded 197 g (77%) of (4) as an off white crystalline solid.
  • 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.66 (m, 4H), 2.57 (m, 2H), 2.92 (m, 2H), 6.70 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 7.01 (d, J=8.5, Hz, 2H). CI MS m/z=166 [C10H15NO+H]+.
  • N-Cbz-4-(4-hydroxyphenyl)butylamine (29)
  • 4-(4-Hydroxyphenyl)butylamine hydrobromide (4) (197 g, 0.80 mole), water (1 L), 1,4-dioxane (1 L) and sodium bicarbonate (336 g, 4 mole) were combined and stirred while cooled in an ice-methanol cooling bath. Benzyl chloroformate (141 mL, 0.96 mole) was dripped in over 5 min. at −2° C. with no appreciable exotherm observed. This was stirred and allowed to warm to room temperature as the cooling bath thawed overnight. An additional quantity of benzyl chloroformate (8 mL, 0.54 mol) was dripped in and this was allowed to stir for 2 h. The product mixture was then evaporated to approximately 500 mL and transferred to a 2 L separatory funnel with ethyl acetate while decanting away from the solids. The aqueous layer was extracted with ethyl acetate (3×1 L). The extracts were combined, washed with brine, dried over sodium sulfate, filtered and evaporated to afford 265 g of the crude product. A portion of the crude product (130 g) was chromatographed (silica gel, 5:1 hexanes/ethyl acetate) using toluene to load the column. The remaining crude material was crystallized from 1:1 toluene/heptane. This material was suction filtered to collect the solid and washed with 1:1 toluene/heptane.
    This material was vacuum desiccated at 45° C. for 2 h. The combined yield of compound (29) was 150 g (62%) of a white crystalline solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.43-1.65 (m, 4H), 2.52 (t, J=7.4 Hz, 2H), 3.19 (q, J=6.4 Hz, 2H), 4.78 (br s, 1H), 5.09 (s, 2H), 5.77 (s, 1H), 6.74 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 6.98 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 7.34 (s, 5). CI MS m/z=300 [C18H21NO3+H]+.
  • N-Cbz-4-[4-(2,3-dihydroxypropyloxy)phenyl]butylamine (31)
  • N-Cbz-4-(4-hydroxyphenyl)butylamine (31) (30 g, 0.10 mole), glycidol (8.0 mL, 0.12 mole) ethanol (30 mL) and triethylamine (0.7 mL, 0.005 mole) were stirred at reflux under argon for 2 h. The product mixture was evaporated, taken up in hot ethyl acetate and suction filtered through a plug of silica gel, eluting with ethyl acetate. After evaporating to a white solid, this solid was re-crystallized from toluene to afford 21.8 g (58%) of compound (31).
  • 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.42-1.65 (m, 4H), 2.54 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 2H), 3.11 (t, J=6.4 Hz, 2H), 3.58-3.71 (m, 2H), 3.88-4.04 (m, 3H), 5.05 (s, 2H), 6.84 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 2H), 7.06 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 7.32 (s, 5H).
  • 4-[4-(2,3-propanediol-1-oxy)phenyl]butylamine (32)
  • N-Cbz-4-[4-(2,3-dihydroxypropyloxy)phenyl]butylamine (31) (67 g, 0.179 mole), ethanol (900 mL), acetic acid (50 mL) and 50% wet 10% palladium on carbon (10 g) were stirred at atmospheric pressure under H2. After stirring overnight, the reaction was purged with nitrogen and suction filtered through a pad of celite. This was evaporated and then co-evaporated 3 times with ethanol (500 mL). The residue was chromatographed (silica gel, 100:10:1 methylene chloride/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) to afford 38 g (89%) of pure compound (32).
  • 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.42-1.55 (m, 2H), 1.55-1.68 (m, 2H), 2.56 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 2H), 2.65 (t, J=7.2 Hz, 2H), 3.58-3.72 (m, 2H), 3.89-4.05 (m, 3H), 6.85 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 2H), 7.08 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 2H).
  • Example 5 4-[4-(2,3-Diacetoxypropyloxy)phenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide (36)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00025
  • N-Cbz-4-[(2,3-diacetoxypropyloxy)phenyl]butylamine (34)
  • Acetic anhydride (0.6 ml, 6 mmol) was added to solution of 31 (0.55 g, 1.5 mmol) in dry pyridine (50 mL) under stirring. The reaction mixture was stirred 3 h at 25° C. and 3 h at 40° C. (oil bath). After this time, the reaction was quenched with 2N HCl (100 mL) and extracted with ethyl acetate. The organic fraction was washed with water and dried over sodium sulfate. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure to provide 34 (0.6 g 86%) as a white powder. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.55 (m, 4H), 1.98 (s, 3H), 2.02 (s, 3H), 2.55 (m, 2H), 4.08 (m, 2H), 4.30 (m, 2H), 4.45 (m, 1H), 4.80 (br s, 1H), 5.08 (s, 2H), 5.38 (m, 1H), 6.82 (d, 2H), 7.08 (d, 2H), 7.35 (s, 5H).
  • 4-[(2,3-diacetoxypropyloxy)phenyl]butylamine (35)
  • Cbz-protected amine 34 (0.6 g, 1.3 mmol) was dissolved in methanol (25 mL) containing 1% acetic acid then Pd/C (0.22 g, 5% wet.) was added. The reaction mixture was stirred for 3 h under hydrogen (1 atm), then the solution was filtered through a pad of silica gel and the solvent was evaporated to give amine 35 (0.37 g, 86%) as a clear oil.
  • 4-[4-(2,3-Diacetoxypropyloxy)phenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide (36)
  • 1-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl-2-methyl-pseudothiourea hydroiodide (0.37 g, 0.95 mmol) was added to a solution of 35 (0.27 g, 0.7 mmol) in a mixture of THF (40 mL) and diisopropylethylamine (1 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at reflux (66° C.) for 6 h. After this time, the solvent was evaporated and the residue was dissolved in MeOH. Silica gel (25 mL) was added and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure to adsorb the compound onto the silica gel. This silica gel was added to the top of a silica gel column and flash chromatography (silica gel, 10:1:0.1 chloroform/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) was performed to obtain crude 36 (128 mg). A second chromatography gave pure 36 (14 mg, 3.7%) as a yellow powder. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.56 (m, 4H), 2.05 (s, 6H), 2.58 (m, 2H), 3.14 (m, 2H), 4.10 (m, 2H), 4.28 (m, 2H), 5.28 (br s, 1H), 6.58 (br s, 2H), 6.82 (m, 2H), 7.10 (m, 2H). APCI MS m/z=536[C23H30ClN7O6+H]+.
  • Example 6 4-[4-(2,2 Dimethyl-[1,3] dioxolan-4 yl)methyloxyphenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide (37)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00026
  • 4-[4-(2,2 Dimethyl-[1,3] dioxolan-4 yl)methyloxyphenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide (37)
  • Compound 33 (150 mg, 0.3 mmol) was suspended in dry acetone (50 mL) then methanol was added until a clear solution was formed (approx. 15 mL). p-Toluenesulfonic acid monohydrate (25 mg) was added along with molecular sieves (5 A) and the reaction mixture was stirred for 48 h at room temperature. After this time, the reaction mixture was filtered, silica gel (20 mL) was added and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. This silica gel with the reaction mixture adsorbed was added to the top of a silica gel flash chromatography column. Compound 37 (120 mg, 81%) was isolated by flash chromatography (silica gel, 10:1:0.1 chloroform/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.30 (s, 3H), 1.34 (s, 3H), 1.52 (br s, 4H), 2.56 (br s, 2H), 3.13 (br s, 2H), 3.71 (m, 1H), 3.92 (m, 2H), 4.08 (m, 1H), 4.45 (m, 1H), 6.64 (br s, 2H), 6.82 (m, 2H), 7.12 (m, 2H). APCI MS m/z=492 [C22H30ClN7O4+H]+.
  • Example 7 4-[4-(Methyl-2,3,4-tri-O-acetyl-glucopyranonuronate-1-O-yl)phenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide (40)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00027
  • 2,3,4-Tri-O-acetyl-1-O-[4-(4-benzyloxycarbonylaminobutyl)phenyl]glucopyranuronic acid methyl ester (38)
  • 2,3,4-Tri-O-acetyl-α-D-glucuronic acid methyl ester trichloroimidate (1.6 g, 3.3 mmol) was added under argon to protected aminophenol 29 in dry methylene chloride (40 mL) then the solution was cooled to −25° C. After stirring for 10 min, BF3.OEt2 (0.045 mL, 0.33 mmol) was added in methylene chloride (5 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred 1.5 h at −25° C., then allowed to warn up to −10° C. and stirring was continued 1 h at that temperature. After this time, the temperature was increased to 25° C. and the reaction mixture was stirred for 1 h then quenched with saturated ammonium chloride (25 mL). The mixture was extracted with methylene chloride then the organic fraction was washed with water and dried over sodium sulfate. The solvent was evaporated and the residue was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, 1:2 ethyl acetate/hexanes) to provide 38 (1.5 g, 72%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.41 (m, 2H), 1.51 (m, 2H), 1.99-2.02 (m, 9H), 2.54 (m, 2H), 3.00 (m, 2H), 3.63 (s, 3H), 4.69 (m, 1H), 4.99 (s, 2H), 5.04-5.10 (m, 2H), 5.46 (m, 1H), 5.60 (m, 1H), 6.88 (d, 2H), 7 12 (d, 2H), 7.27 (m, 1H), 7.33 (s, 5H). APCI MS m/z=616 [C31H37NO12+H]+.
  • 2,3,4-Tri-O-acetyl-1-O-[4-(4-aminobutyl)phenyl]glucopyranuronic acid methyl ester (39)
  • Glucuronide 38 (1.5 g, 2.4 mmol) was dissolved in dry methanol (100 mL) and Pd/C (0.62 g, 5%) was added. The reaction mixture was stirred under hydrogen (1 atm) for 2.5 h at room temperature. After this time, the solution was passed through a pad of silica gel and the solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure to give amine 39 (0.94 g, 84%). 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.46 (m, 2H), 1.60 (m, 2H), 2.08 (m, 9H), 2.58 (m, 2H), 2.72 (m, 2H), 3.63 (s, 3H), 4.14 (m, 1H), 5.10 (m, 1H), 5.34 (m, 3H), 6.90 (d, 2H), 7.12 (d, 2H).
  • 4-[4-( Methyl 2,3,4-tri-O-acetyl-glucopyranonuronate-1-O-yl)phenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide (40)
  • 1-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl-2-methyl-pseudothiourea hydroiodide (0.30 g, 0.8 mmol) was added to a solution of 39 (0.4 g, 0.8 mmol) in a mixture of THF (40 mL) and diisopropylethylamine (3 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at reflux (66° C.) for 2 h. After this time, the solvent was evaporated and the residue was suspended in THF. Silica gel (15 mL) was added and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. This silica gel was transferred onto the top of a silica gel chromatography column. The target compound 40 (0.32 g, 48%) was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, 12:1:0.1 chloroform/ethanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) and isolated as a yellow powder. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.61 (br s, 4H), 2.05 (s, 9H), 2.55 (m, 2H), 3.49 (br s, 2H), 3.71 (m, 3H), 4.22 (m, 1H), 5.12 (m, 1H), 5.34 (m, 3H), 6.88 (m, 2H), 7 04 (d, 2H). APCI MS m/z=694 [C29H36ClN7O11+H]+.
  • Example 8 4-[4-(5-Carboxy-glucopyranonuronate-1-O-yl)-phenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide (41)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00028
  • 4-[4-(5-Carboxy-2,3,4-tri-O-acetyl-glucopyranonuronate-1-O-yl)phenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide (41)
  • Compound 40 (0.31 g, 0.44 mmol) was added to mixture of THF/water (1:1, 40 mL) and the resulting cloudy solution was cooled to −10° C. A solution of NaOH in water (4 mL of 1.24 N solution) was added and stirring was continued at 10° C. for 1.5 h. After this time, the reaction mixture was allowed to warm up to room temperature and the THF was removed under reduced pressure. The pH of the remaining solution was adjusted to 6 by drop wise addition of 1N HCl. The formed precipitate was collected by centrifugation and washed with cold water (3×20 mL). Compound 41 (0.18 g, 75%) was isolated as a yellow powder after drying under vacuum for 48 h. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.56 (br s, 4H), 2.56 (m, 2H), 3.19 (m, 2H), 3.15-3.40 (br s., 1H), 3.25 (m, 2H), 3.57 (m, 1H), 4.87 (m, 1H), 5.10-5.40 (br d, 1H), 6.89 (m, 2H), 7.06 (m, 2H). APCI MS m/z=554 [C29H36ClN7O11+H]+.
  • Example 9 4-[4-(5-Carboxy-glucopyranonuronate-1-O-yl)phenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide trifluoroacetate (42)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00029
  • 4-Methylphenylsulfonic acid 4-(4-methoxyphenyl)butyl ester (1)
  • Pyridine (15 mL) was added drop wise to a cooled (0° C.) solution of 4-(4-methoxyphenyl)butanol (10.0 g, 0.055 mol) and p-toluenesulfonyl chloride (13.6 g, 0.072 mol) in dry chloroform (100 mL) under stirring. The reaction mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature. After this time, the reaction was quenched with 10% HCl (300 mL) and extracted with chloroform. The organic fraction was washed with saturated NaHCO3, water and dried over magnesium sulfate. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue purified by flash chromatography (eluent: hexane/ethyl acetate 15:1) to provide 12.9 g (66%) of 1 as clear oil. 1H NMR (360 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.61 (m, 4H), 2.44 (s, 3H), 2.52 (m, 2H), 3.78 (s, 3H), 4.05 (m, 2H), 6.77 (d, 2H), 7.05 (d, 2H), 7.34 (d, 2H), 7.78 (d, 2H).
  • 4-(4-Methoxyphenyl)butylazide (2)
  • Sodium azide (3.07 g, 0.047 mol) was added to a solution of 1 (12.9 g, 0.04 mol) in anhydrous DMF (70 mL) and the reaction mixture was stirred 12 h at 80° C. (oil bath). Then solvent was removed at reduced pressure and the residual oil was treated with a mixture of CH2Cl2/ether 3:1 (100 mL). The resulting solution was washed with water (2×100 mL), brine and dried over magnesium sulfate. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and 7.6 g (95%) of 2 was obtained. The purity of 2 (99%) was determined by GC and TLC (eluent: hexane/ethyl acetate 1:1), Rf=0.84.
  • 4-(4-Methoxyphenyl)butylamine (3). Typical procedure A
  • Lithium aluminum hydride (LAH) (55 mL of a 1.0 M solution in THF, 0.055 mol) was added drop wise to a solution of 2 (7.6 g, 0.037 mol) in dry THF (70 mL) at 0° C. The mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature in an argon atmosphere then the mixture was treated with water (1.5 mL), then 15% NaOH (1.5 mL), then with more water (3 mL) and filtered. The solid precipitate was washed with THF. The combined organic fractions were dried over magnesium sulfate and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure to give 6.2 g (94%) of 3. The purity of 3 (99%) was determined by GC. 1H NMR (360 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.34 (m, 2H), 1.54 (m, 2H), 2.51 (m, 4H), 3.70 (s, 3H), 6.83 (d, 2H), 7.08 (d, 2H). 13C (90 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 28.6, 330, 34.1, 41.5, 54.8, 113.1, 129.1, 132.2, 157.3
  • 4-(4-Hydroxyphenyl)butylamine hydrobromide (4). Typical procedure B
  • Amine 3 (2.32 g, 0.012 mol) was stirred in boiling 48% HBr (50 mL) for 3 h. After the reaction was completed, argon was bubbled through the solution and the solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure. The solid residue was dried above KOH to provide 3.1 g (90%) of 4. APCI MS m/z=166[C10H15NO+H]+
  • 4-(4-Hydroxyphenyl)butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (5)
  • 1-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl-2-methyl-pseudothiourea hydroiodide (0.4 g, 1.03 mmol) was added to a suspension of 4-(4-hydroxyphenyl)butylamine hydrobromide (4) (0.8 g, 32 mmol) in a mixture of THF (35 mL) and triethylamine (3 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred in the boiling solvent for 3 h, then the supernatant was separated and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The oily residue was washed with water (2×30 mL), ether (3×30 mL) and then 10% HCl (40 mL) was added. The mixture was vigorously stirred for 10 min then the yellow solid was filtered off, dried and recrystallized twice from ethanol to give 5 (0.18 g, 41%) as yellow solid. Purity is 98% by HPLC, retention time is 9.77 min. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.56 (br s, 4H), 2.48 (br s, 2H), 3.35 (m, 2H), 6.65 (d, 2H), 6.95 (d, 2H), 7.50 (br s, 2H), 8.75 (br s, 1H), 9.05 (br s, 1H), 9.33 (br s, 2H), 10.55 (s, 1H).
  • 13C NMR (75 MHz, CD3OD) 28.7, 29.8, 35.4, 42.4, 111.2, 116.1, 122.0, 130.0, 134.0, 155.0, 156.1, 156.8, 157.5, 167.0. APCI MS m/z=378 [C16H20ClN7O2+H]+.
  • 4-[4-(5-Carboxy-glucopyranonuronate-1-O-yl)phenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide trifluoroacetate (42)
  • Compound 5 (29 mg, 0.07 mmol) was dissolved in DMF (2 mL). A 100 mM TRIS buffer solution, pH 7.5, containing 10 mM MgCl2, 1.0 mM dithiothreitol, 10 mM saccharolactone, and 2 mM CMP (cytidine-mono-phosphate) was made. 176 mg of UDP-GA (uridine-di-phospho-glucuronic acid) was dissolved in the buffer solution (30 mL) and added to 600 mg of bovine liver microsomes (produced at AMRI Biocatalysis Division) in a 50 mL widemouth jar. The DMF solution of 5 was added to initiate the reaction. The reaction was run at room temperature with periodic shaking by hand and was stopped by the addition of an equal volume of MeCN after 42 h. The reaction solution was divided into two (50 mL) centrifuge tubes and centrifuged to remove the enzyme. The precipitated enzyme was re-suspended in MeCN (40 mL) and centrifuged again. This enzyme wash was repeated 3 times until the LC/MS analysis showed only trace amounts of remaining product. The supernatants were combined and the aqueous MeCN was removed under vacuum at 30° C. The resulting syrup was thinned by the addition of MeCN and further dried under vacuum overnight. After drying, the syrup was purified by RP-HPLC (Luna C18 (2) 250×21.2 mm, 5 μm) with a water/acetonitrile (both containing 0.1% TFA) gradient. The appropriate fractions were combined and dried under vacuum to yield 42 (14.8 mg, 28.2%) with 98.4% purity (by HPLC analysis) as a white solid. APCI MS m/z=554 [C29H36ClN7O11+H]+, m/z=552[C29H36ClN7O11—H].
  • Example 10 4-[4-(1,4-Dioxapent-1-yl)phenyl] butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (66)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00030
  • N-Cbz-4-[4-(1,4-dioxapent-1-yl)phenyl]butylamine (64)
  • To a vigorously stirred solution of 29 (4 g, 0.013 mol) in anhydrous THF (150 mL) under nitrogen at 0° C. was added sodium hydride (60% dispersion in mineral oil, 0.64 g, 0.016 mol). The mixture was stirred for 15 min then tetrabutylammonium iodide (0.5 g, 0.0013 mol) and 2-bromoethyl methyl ether (2.04 g, 0.015 mol) were added and the mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the material was purified by column chromatography (silica gel, 10:1 methylene chloride/ethyl acetate) to provide 64 (3.1 g, 64%). 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.60 (m, 4H), 2.59 (m, 2H), 3.23 (m, 2H), 3.45 (s, 3H), 3.77 (m, 2H), 4.10 (m, 2H), 5.13 (s, 2H), 6.88 (d, 2H), 7.08 (d, 2H), 7.47 (s, 5H).
  • 4-(1,4-Dioxapent-1-yl)phenylbutylamine (65)
  • To a solution of 64 (2.27 g, 6.4 mmol) in ethanol (60 mL) with acetic acid (1 wt. %) was added Pd/C catalyst (300 mg, 10% wet) then the mixture was shaken for 18 h at 30 psi of hydrogen in a Parr hydrogenator. The pressure was released and the catalyst was filtered off through a pad of silica gel. The solvent was removed at reduced pressure to provide 65 (1.3 g, 92%). 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.60 (br s, 4H), 2.00 (s, 2H) 2.55 (br s, 2H), 2.85 (br s, 2H), 3.47 (s, 3H), 3.73 (m, 2H), 4.10 (m, 2H), 6.82 (d, 2H), 7.08 (d, 2H).
  • 4-[4-(1,4-Dioxapent-1-yl)phenyl] butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (66)
  • 1-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl-2-methyl-pseudothiourea hydroiodide (0.3 g, 0.77 mmol) was added to an anhydrous THF solution (20 mL) of 65 (0.48 g, 2.3 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at reflux for 11 h then the solvent was evaporated. The residue was purified on a Biotage system (silica gel, 10:1:0.1 chloroform/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide). The appropriate fractions were collected, the solvent was evaporated and the residue was treated with 3% HCl. The yellow precipitate that formed was separated and washed with ethyl acetate, water and dried to provide 66 (160 mg, 34%) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.57 (br s, 4H), 2.52 (m, 4H), 3.30 (s, 3H), 3.63 (m, 2H), 4.03 (m, 2H) 6.85 (d, 2H), 7.12 (d, 2H), 7.46 (br s, 2H), 8.00 (br s, 1H), 8.85 (br s, 1H), 8.99 (br s, 1H), 9.32 (br s, 1H), 10.03 (s, 1H). APCI MS m/z 436 [C19H26ClN7O3+H]+.
  • Example 11 4-(4-Hydroxymethylphenyl)butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (68)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00031
  • 4-(4-Hydroxymethylphenyl)butyl amine (67)
  • Lithium aluminum hydride (35 mL of a 1.0 M solution in THF, 0.035 mol) was added drop wise to a vigorously stirred solution of 4-(4-carboxymethylphenyl)butylazide 8 (2.4 g, 0.010 mol) in dry THF (120 mL) at 0° C. and stirred overnight at room temperature under a nitrogen atmosphere. To break up the complex water (1.5 mL), 15% NaOH (1.5 mL) and water (4.5 mL) were added drop wise to the cold reaction mixture. The white solid precipitate was filtered off and washed with THF. All organics phases were combined and evaporated. The material was purified by column chromatography (silica gel, 2:1:0.05 chloroform/ethanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) to provide 67 (1.17 g, 64%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.15 (br s, 2H), 1.54 (br s, 2H) 1.70 (br s, 2H), 2.60 (m, 4H), 3.77 (s, 1H), 4.67 (s, 2H), 7.47 (s, 2H), 7.60 (s, 2H).
  • 4-(4-Hydroxymethylphenyl)butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (68)
  • 1-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl-2-methyl-pseudothiourea hydroiodide (0.2 g, 0.52 mmol) was added to an anhydrous THF suspension (20 mL) of 67 (0.37 g, 2.06 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at reflux for 3 h then the solvent was evaporated. The residue was washed with ethyl acetate (3×15 mL), dried and treated with 3% HCl (15 mL). The yellow solid that formed was filtered, washed with water (2×10 mL) and dried to provide 68 (216 mg, 98%). 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.57 (br s, 4H), 2.62 (m, 2H), 3.35 (m, 2H), 3.73 (br s, 4H), 4.45 (s, 2H), 7.12 (d, 2H), 7.24 (d, 2H), 8.85 (br s, 1H), 9.98 (br s, 1H), 9.32 (br s, 1H), 10.55 (s, 1H). APCI MS m/z 392 [C17H22ClN7O3+H]+.
  • Example 12 4-{4-[(2R)-2,3-Dihydroxypropyloxy]phenyl]}butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (71)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00032
  • N-Cbz-4-{[(2R)-2,3-dihydroxypropyloxy]phenyl}butylamine (69)
  • To cold (0° C.) N-Cbz-4-(4-allyloxyphenyl)butylamine 30 (1.94 g, 5.7 mmol) under a nitrogen atmosphere was added cold (0° C.) AD-Mix-α (12 g) in tert-butanol (100 mL) and water (100 mL). The mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature overnight. The mixture was then quenched with saturated sodium sulfite (200 mL), extracted with ethyl acetate (3×100 mL), dried (Na2SO4) and concentrated to give 69 (2 g, 95%) as a beige solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO) δ 1.40 (m, 2H), 1.54 (m, 2H) 2.55 (br s, 2H), 3.00 (m, 2H), 3.44 (s, 2H), 3.78 (m, 2H), 3.94 (m, 1H), 4.68 (br s, 1H), 4.93 (s, 1H), 5.00 (s, 2H), 6.83 (d, 2H), 7.08 (d, 2H), 7.30 (br s, 1H), 7.35 (s, 5H).
  • 4-{[(2R)-2,3-dihydroxypropyloxy]phenyl}butylamine (70)
  • To a vigorously stirred solution of 69 (2 g, 5.4 mmol) in methanol (60 mL) under nitrogen was added Pd/C (10% wet, 0.5 g). The mixture was stirred 2 h at room temperature under an atmosphere of hydrogen then the pressure was released and the mixture was filtered through a pad of silica gel. The solvent was removed and the residue was purified by column chromatography (silica gel, 2:1:0.2 chloroform/ethanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) to provide 70 (1.18 g, 92%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.32 (m, 2H), 1.54 (m, 2H), 2.55 (m, 2H), 3.45 (m, 2H), 3.82 (m, 3H), 3.94 (m, 2H), 6.83 (d, 2H), 7.08 (d, 2H).
  • 4-{4-[(2R)-2,3-Dihydroxypropyloxy]phenyl]}butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (71)
  • 1-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl-2-methyl-pseudothiourea hydroiodide (0.4 g, 1.03 mmol) was added to an anhydrous THF suspension (50 mL) of 70 (0.49 g, 2.00 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at reflux for 5 h then the mixture was cooled and the precipitate that formed was collected and washed with 3% HCl (2×5 mL) then dried to provide 71 (290 mg, 58%) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.57 (s, 4H), 2.55 (d, 2H), 3.35 (d, 2H), 3.90 (m, 5H), 6.82 (d, 2H), 7.10 (d, 2H), 7.47 (br s, 2H), 8.75 (br s, 1H), 8.90 (br s, 1H), 10.5 (s, 1H). APCI MS m/z 452 [C19H26ClN7O4+H]+.
  • Example 13 4-{4-[(2S)-2,3-Dihydroxypropyloxyl]phenyl]}butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (74)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00033
  • N-Cbz-4-{[(2S)-2,3-dihydroxypropyloxy]phenyl}butylamine (72)
  • To cold (0° C.) N-Cbz-4-(4-allyloxyphenyl)butylamine 30 (1.53 g, 4.5 mmol) under a nitrogen atmosphere was added cold (0° C.) AD-Mix-β (9.2 g) in tert-butanol (100 mL) and water (100 mL). The mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature overnight. The mixture was quenched with saturated sodium sulfite (200 mL), extracted with ethyl acetate (3×100 mL), dried (Na2SO4) and concentrated to provide 72 (1.67 g, 99%) as a beige solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.54 (m, 4H) 2.55 (br s, 2H), 3.18 (m, 2H), 3.70 (s, 3H), 4.02 (d, 2H), 4.10 (m, 1H), 4.73 (br s, 1H), 5.08 (s, 2H), 6.83 (d, 2H), 7.08 (d, 2H), 7.38 (s, 1H), 7.35 (s, 5H).
  • 4-{[(2S)-2,3-dihydroxypropyloxy]phenyl}butylamine (73)
  • Compound 73 was prepared in a similar fashion to the synthesis of compound 70 starting from compound 72 (1.67 g, 4.5 mmol). Amine 73 (1.06 g, 99%) was isolated as a white solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.32 (m, 2H), 1.54 (m, 2H), 2.55 (m, 2H), 3.45 (m, 2H), 3.75 (m, 3H), 3.94 (m, 2H), 6.83 (d, 2H), 7.08 (d, 2H).
  • 4-{4-[(2S)-2,3-Dihydroxypropyloxy]phenyl]}butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (74)
  • Compound 74 was prepared in a similar fashion to the synthesis of compound 71 starting from compound 73 (0.74 g, 3.09 mmol). Compound 74 (0.38 g, 76%) was isolated as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.57 (s, 4H), 2.55 (d, 2H), 3.35 (d, 2H), 3.85 (m, 5H), 6.82 (d, 2H), 7.10 (d, 2H), 7.47 (br s, 2H), 8.75 (br s, 1H), 8.90 (br s, 1H), 10.5 (s, 1H). APCI MS m/z 452 [C19H26ClN7O4+H]+.
  • Example 14 4-(4-Aminophenyl)ethylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (83)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00034
  • 4-(4-Aminophenyl)ethylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (83)
  • A mixture of 1-H-pyrazolecarboxamidine hydrochloride (2.8 g, 19 mmol), 4-aminoethylaniline (1.3 mL, 9 mmol) and diisopropylethylamine (1.3 ml) were stirred in dry DMF (5 mL) under argon for 18 h. After this time, ether (30 ml) was added to produce a clear oil. The obtained oil (82) was washed with ether and dried under vacuum (40 mTorr) overnight. After drying 70 mg of oil was taken into dry methanol (3 mL) and 25% NaOH (0.14 mL) was added. The reaction volume was decreased to 1.0 mL and 3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2 carboxylic acid methyl ester (0.1 g, 0.5 mmol) was added. The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight. Another portion of 82 (0.1 g) was dissolved in methanol (1 mL), treated with 25% NaOH (0.15 mL) and the resulting solution was added to the reaction mixture. The reaction mixture was stirred 3 h at reflux, then cooled to room temperature and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in a minimal volume of DMF and separated by preparative HPLC. The obtained fractions were analyzed by LC/MS. The fractions containing product with M+H=349 were collected and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in 10% HCl and evaporated to dryness to produce 83 (23.5 mg, 11%) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (360 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 2.91 (m, 2H), 3.59 (m, 2H), 7.31 (d, 2H), 7.42 (m, 4H), 9.02 (br s., 2H), 9.41 (br s., 1H), 10.56 (s, 1H). 13C NMR (90 MHz, DMSO-d6) 33.1, 42.0, 108.9, 119.6, 120.7, 129.9 (2C), 131.0 (2C), 153.1, 154.1, 155.8, 165.2. API MS m/z=349 [C14H17ClN8O+H]+.
  • Preparative HPLC was performed on a Gilson Combichem using a Luna C18(2) column, 5μ, 250×21.2 mm; Flow rate=20 mL/min; Mobile phase consists of MeCN/water containing 0.1% TFA; Gradient: 10% MeCN from the 0-2 min interval, concentration of MeCN increased from 10 to 40% from 2-10 min, 40 to 100% MeCN from 10-19 min, 100% MeCN from 19-23 min, MeCN decreased from 100 to 10% from 23-25 min.
  • Example 15 4-[4-(1,4,7-Trioxaoct-1-yl)phenyl]-butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (108)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00035
  • 4-[4-(1,4,7-Trioxaoct-1-yl)phenyl]-N-benzyloxycarbonylbutylamine (106)
  • 4-(4-Hydroxyphenyl)-N-benzyloxycarbonylbutylamine (29) (1.0 g, 3.3 mmol), 1-bromo-2-(2-methoxyethoxy)ethane (0.67 g, 3.7 mmol), and potassium carbonate (0.60 g, 4.3 mmol) were combined in acetone (20 mL), and stirred at reflux overnight. The reaction was allowed to cool, and then filtered and evaporated. The residue was re-subjected in methyl ethyl ketone (10 mL), 1-bromo-2-(2-methoxyethoxy)ethane (0.91 g, 5.0 mmol), potassium carbonate (0.74 g, 5.3 mmol), and sodium iodide (0.5 g, 3.3 mmol) with stirring at reflux for 2.5 h. The reaction was allowed to cool, and was filtered and evaporated. The residue was re-subjected in DMF (10 mL), with 1-bromo-2-(2-methoxyethoxy)ethane (1.8 g, 9.8 mmol), potassium carbonate (1.60 g, 11.6 mmol), and sodium iodide (0.4 g, 2.7 mmol), overnight with stirring at 70° C. The reaction was evaporated to remove the solvent and then was dissolved in ethyl acetate (70 mL). The organic extract was washed with water (3×20 mL), dried over potassium carbonate and filtered. Evaporation afforded 1.1 g of an oil which was purified by column chromatography (silica gel, 2:1 hexanes/ethyl acetate) to afford 800 mg (70%) of pure product 106. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.42-1.68 (m, 4H), 2.55 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 2H), 3.20 (q, J=6.2 Hz, 2H), 3.39 (s, 3H), 3.55-3.60 (m, 2H), 3.69-3.74 (m, 2H), 3.82-3.87 (m, 2H), 4.11 (t, 5.3 Hz, 2H), 4.71 (br s, 1H), 5.09 (s, 2H), 6.82 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 7.05 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 7.34 (s, 5H). CI MS m/z=402 [C23H31NO5+H]+.
  • 4-[4-(1,4,7-Trioxaoct-1-yl)phenyl]butylamine (107)
  • Compound 106 (800 mg, 2.0 mmol) in ethanol (20 mL), was subjected to 1 atmosphere of H2 in the presence of 10% palladium on carbon (100 mg, cat.) with stirring for 5 h. After standing overnight, the reaction was purged with N2 then suction filtered through celite and washed off the celite with methylene chloride. The solvents were evaporated and chromatographed (silica gel, 200:10:1 methylene chloride/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) to afford 530 mg (>99%) of amine 107. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.31 (br s, 2H), 1.41-1.52 (m, 2H), 1.55-1.67 (m, 2H), 2.56 (t, J=7.7 Hz, 2H), 2.70 (t, J=7.0 Hz, 2H), 3.39 (s, 3H), 3.58 (m, 2H), 3.72 (m, 2H), 3.84 (t, J=4.9 Hz, 2H), 4.12 (t, J=5.3 Hz, 2H), 6.83 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 2H), 7.07 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 2H). CI MS m/z=268 [C15H25NO3+H]+.
  • 4-[4-(1,4,7-Trioxaoct-1-yl)phenyl]-butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (108)
  • Amine 107 (200 mg, 0.75 mmol), 1-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl-2-methyl-pseudothiourea hydroiodide (296 mg, 0.76 mmol) and triethylamine (0.52 mL, 3.73 mmol) were combined in THF (5 mL) and stirred at reflux under N2 for 1.5 h. After stirring at room temperature for two days, the reaction was evaporated. The residue was chromatographed (silica gel, 400:10:1 to 200:10:1 gradient elution, methylene chloride/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) to afford the free base of the product (290 mg). This material was stirred in methanol (20 mL) at 0° C. then 1M HCl (3 mL) was added. The solution was evaporated with no heating and then co-evaporated with methanol. The residue was dissolved in methanol and then precipitated by the addition of ethyl acetate. This precipitate was centrifuged and the supernatant was decanted. The gel like pellet was evaporated, co-evaporated with water (2 mL) and then placed on high vacuum overnight. This afforded 129 mg (42%) of compound 108 as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.58 (m, 4H), 2.58 (br s, 2H), 3.25 (s, 3H), 3.33 (m, 2H), 3.45 (m, 2H), 3.58 (m, 2H), 3.72 (m, 2H), 3.04 (m, 2H), 4.92 (br s, 4H), 6.85 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 7.12 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 2H), 8.10 to 7.26 (br m, 3H), 8.94 (br d, 2H), 9.32 (br s, 1H), M.P.=110-125° C. APCI MS m/z=480 [C21H30ClN7O4+H]+.
  • Example 16 4-[4-(1,4,7,10,13-pentoxatetradec-1-yl)phenyl]-butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (112)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00036
  • O-Tosyltetraethyleneglycol methyl ether (109)
  • Tetraethyleneglycol monomethyl ether (2.0 g, 9.6 mmol) was combined with pyridine (0.93 mL, 11.5 mmol) in methylene chloride (20 mL) at 0° C. p-Toluenesulfonyl chloride (2.2 g, 11.5 mmol) dissolved in methylene chloride (10 mL) was added dropwise and the reaction was allowed to warm to room temperature as the ice bath thawed. After stirring nine days, the product mixture was transferred to a separatory funnel with water (70 mL). The layers were separated and the aqueous layer was extracted with methylene chloride (3×20 mL). The extracts were combined and evaporated. The residue (3.3 g) was chromatographed (silica gel, 4:1 to 3:1 gradient elution, methylene chloride/ethyl acetate) to afford 2.5 g (70%) of compound 109 as an oil. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.56 (br s, 4H), 2.42 (br s, 2H), 3.34 (br s, 4H), 6.05 (s, 3H), 7.09 (s, 0.5H), 7.26 (s, 0.5H), 7.42 (br s, 2H), 7.70 (br s, 2H), 8.87 (br d, 2H), 9.07 (s, 2H), 9.22 (br s, 1H), 10.51 (s, 1H). CI MS m/z=363 [C16H26O7S+H]+.
  • 4-[4-(1,4,7,10,13-pentoxatetradec-1-yl)phenyl]-N-benzyloxycarbonylbutylamine (110)
  • 4-(4-Hydroxyphenyl)-N-benzyloxycarbonylbutylamine (29) (0.30 g, 1.0 mmol), O-tosyltetraethyleneglycol methyl ether (109) (1.45 g, 4.0 mmol), potassium carbonate (0.69 g, 5 mmol) and sodium iodide (0.6 g, 4.0 mmol) were combined in DMF (5 mL) and stirred at 55° C. overnight. Cesium carbonate (0.33 g, 1.0 mmol) was added and the reaction was stirred at 70° C. overnight. The mixture was allowed to cool and was then partitioned between 1:1 toluene/ethyl acetate (70 mL) and water (20 mL). The layers were separated and the organic layer was washed with water (4×10 mL), brine (2×30 mL), dried over sodium sulfate and evaporated. Chromatography (silica gel, 3:1 methylene chloride/ethyl acetate) afforded 400 mg (81%) of compound 110. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.44-1.67 (m, 4H), 2.55 (t, J=7.7 Hz, 2H), 3.20 (q, J=6.0 Hz, 2H), 3.37 (s, 3H), 3.54 (m, 2H), 3.61-3.75 (m, 10H), 3.84 (t, J=4.9 Hz, 2H), 4.10 (t, 5.5 Hz, 2H), 4.71 (br. s, 1H), 5.09 (s, 2H), 6.82 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 7.05 (d, J=8.6 Hz, 2H), 7.34 (s, 5H).
  • 4-[4-(1,4,7,10,13-pentoxatetradec-1-yl)phenyl]butylamine (111)
  • This compound was prepared in a similar fashion to the synthesis of amine 107 from compound 110 (385 mg, 0.78 mmol) to give 266 mg (95%) of compound 111. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.41-1.54 (m, 2H), 1.60 (br. s, 2H), 2.56 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 2H), 2.70 (t, J=7.0 Hz, 2H), 3.37 (s, 3H), 3.51-3.58 (m, 2H), 3.60-3.77 (m, 10H), 3.84 (m, 2H), 4.10 (t, 5.5 Hz, 2H), 6.83 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H), 7.07 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 2H).
  • 4-[4-(1,4,7,10,13-pentoxatetradec-1-yl)phenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (112)
  • This compound was prepared in a similar fashion to the synthesis of compound 108 from compound III (250 mg, 0.70 mmol) and 1-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl-2-methyl-pseudothiourea hydroiodide (200 mg, 0.51 mmol) to give 130 mg (46%) of compound 112. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.57 (br s, 4H), 2.55 (br s, 2H), 3.05 to 3.90 (m, 21H), 6.85 (d, J=7.6 Hz, 2H), 7.12 (d, J=7.4 Hz, 2H), 7.44 (br s, 1H), 8.10-7.40 (m, 2H), 8.93 (br d, 2H), 9.32 (s, 1H), 10.55 (s, 1H). APCI MS m/z=568 [C25H38ClN7O6S+H]+.
  • Example 17 4-[4-(2-Hydroxyethyloxy)phenyl)]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (116)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00037
  • N-{4-[4-(2-hydroxyethyloxy)phenyl]but-3-yn-1-yl}phthalimide (113)
  • 2-(4-Bromophenoxy)ethanol (3 g, 14.5 mmol), palladium (II) chloride (0.2 g, 1.1 mmol) and triphenylphosphine (0.6 g, 2.2 mmol) were dissolved in triethylamine (70 mL) then copper(I) iodide (0.45 g, 2.1 mmol) and N-(but-3-yn)phthalimide (3.2 g, 16 mmol) were added. The reaction mixture was stirred for 72 h at room temperature and 5 h at 50° C. (oil bath), then the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. Ethyl acetate (150 mL) was added to the residue and the mixture was washed with 2N HCl, brine and water. The organic fraction was isolated, dried with sodium sulfate and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The product 113 (1.7 g, 43%) was isolated by flash chromatography (silica gel, 10:1:2 methylene chloride/ethyl acetate/hexanes) as a brown oil. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 2.80 (m, 2H), 3.95 (m, 4H), 4.08 (m, 2H), 6.83 (d, 2H), 7.35 (m, 2H), 7.72 (m, 2H), 7.88 (m, 2H).
  • N-{4-[4-(2-hydroxyethyloxy)phenyl]butyl}phthalimide (114)
  • A solution of 113 (1.7 g, 5.1 mmol) in a mixture of methanol/ethyl acetate (80 and 10 mL correspondingly) was placed in a 0.5 L Parr flask and palladium on carbon (1.1 g, 5% wet. Pd/C) was added. The reaction mixture was shaken at 50 psi of hydrogen pressure at room temperature overnight. After this time, the mixture was filtered through a silica gel pad and the solvent was removed at reduced pressure to give crude 114 (1.2 g) as a brown oil. The crude 114 was used in the next step without further purification.
  • 4-[4-(2-hydroxyethyloxy)phenyl]butyl amine (115)
  • The crude protected amine 114 (1.2 g, 35 mmol) was dissolved in 40 mL of a 2 N solution of methyl amine in dry methanol and the reaction mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature. After this time the solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, 5:1:0.1 chloroform/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) to give free amine 115 (0.25 g, 35%) as a clear oil. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.58 (m, 4H), 2.55 (m, 2H), 2.73 (m, 2H), 3.83 (m, 2H), 3.97 (m, 2H), 6.83 (d, 2H), 7.07 (d, 2H), 7.82 (s, 1H).
  • 4-[4-(2-hydroxyethyloxy)phenyl)]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride (116)
  • 1-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl-2-methyl-pseudothiourea hydroiodide (0.32 g, 0.8 mmol) was added to a solution of amine 115 (0.25 g, 1.2 mmol) in a mixture of THF (15 mL), methanol (5 mL) and diisopropylethylamine (1 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at reflux for 3.5 h and then cooled to room temperature. The formed precipitate was isolated, washed with ethyl acetate (2×5 mL) and treated with 5% HCl (10 mL). The resulting solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water and dried under vacuum to give compound 116 (0.25 g, 73%) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.56 (m, 4H), 2.57 (m, 2H), 3.32 (m, 2H), 3.70 (m, 2H), 3.93 (m, 2H), 4.90 (t, 1H), 6.84 (d, 2H), 7.12 (d, 2H), 7.45 (s, 2H), 8.70 (br s, 1H), 8.88 (br s, 1H), 9.12 (br s, 1H) 10.45 (s, 1H). APCI MS m/z=422 [C18H24ClN7O3+H]+.
  • Example 18 4-[4-(2-Hydroxypropyloxy)phenyl)]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00038
  • Using general procedure Z, 4-[4-(2-hydroxypropyloxy)phenyl]butyl amine was converted into 4-[4-(2-hydroxypropyloxy)phenyl)]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride, m.p. 212-214° C., APCI MS, M/Z=436 [C19H26ClN7O3+H]+.
  • Example 19 4-[4-(3-Hydroxypropyloxy)phenyl)]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00039
  • Using general procedure Z, 4-[4-(3-hydroxypropyloxy)phenyl]butyl amine was converted into 4-[4-(3-hydroxypropyloxy)phenyl)]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride, m.p. 211-213° C., APCI MS, M/Z=436 [C19H26ClN7O3+H]+.
  • Example 20 4-[4-(2-{Tetrahydropyan-2-yl}oxyethyloxy)phenyl)]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00040
  • Using general procedure Z, 4-[4-(2-{tetrahydropyan-2-yl}oxyethyloxy)phenyl]butyl amine was converted into 4-[4-(2-{tetrahydropyan-2-yl}oxyethyloxy)phenyl)] butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide, m.p. 161° C., APCI Mass Spectrum, M/Z=506 [C23H32ClN7O4+H].+
  • Example 21 4-[3-(2-,3-Dihydroxypropyloxyl)phenyl)]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00041
  • Using general procedure Z, 4-[3-(2,3-dihydroxypropyloxy)phenyl]butylamine was converted into 4-[3-(2,3-dihydroxypropyloxy)phenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride, m.p. 91-93° C., APCI Mass Spectrum, M/Z=452 [C19H26ClN7O4+H]+.
  • Example 22 4-[2-(2-,3-Dihydroxypropyloxy)phenyl)]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00042
  • Using general procedure Z, 4-[2-(2,3-dihydroxypropyloxy)phenyl]butylamine was converted into 4-[2-(2,3-dihydroxypropyloxy)phenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride, m.p. 200-205° C., APCI Mass Spectrum, M/Z=452 [C19H26ClN7O4+H]+.
  • Example 23 4-[4-(2,3,4-Trihydroxybutyloxy)phenyl)]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00043
  • Using general procedure Z, 4-[4(2,3,4-trihydroxybutyloxy)phenyl]butylamine was converted into 4-[4-(2,3,4-trihydroxybutyloxy)phenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride. m.p. 148° C. (dec), APCI Mass Spectrum, M/Z=482 [C20H28ClN7O5+H].+
  • Example 24 4-[4-(4-Amino)phenyl)]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00044
  • Using general procedure Z, 4-[(4-amino)phenyl]butylamine was converted into 4-[4-(4-amino)phenyl]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride. m.p. 195-200° (dec), APCI Mass Spectrum, M/Z=377 [C16H21ClN8O4+H+].+
  • Example 25 4-[4-(2-aminoethyloxy)phenyl)butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00045
  • Using general procedure Z, 4-[4-(2{t-butoxycarbonylamino}ethyloxy)phenyl]butyl amine was converted into 4-[4-(2-{t-butoxycarbonylamino}ethyloxy)phenyl)]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide, m.p. 118° C., APCI MS M/Z=521 [C23H33ClN8O4+H]+, which was hydrolyzed and acidified with HCL to give 4-[4-(2-aminoethyloxy)phenyl)butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride, m. p. >178° C. (dec), M/Z=421 [C18H25ClN8O2].
  • Example 26 4-{4-(2-Hydroxyethyl)phenyl)butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00046
  • Using general procedure Z, 4-[4-(2-hydroxyethyl)phenyl)]butyl amine was converted into 4-[4-(2-hydroxyethyl)phenyl)]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride, m.p. 218-219° C., API M/Z=406[C18H24ClN7O2H]+.
  • Example 27 4-[3-(2-Hydroxyethyloxy)phenyl)butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00047
  • Using general procedure Z, 4-[3-(2-hydroxyethyloxy)phenyl)butyl amine was converted to 4-[(3-(2-hydroxyethyloxy)phenyl)]butylamidino-3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinecarboxamide hydrochloride, m.p. 161-163° C. (dec), AMPI MS M/Z=422[C18H24ClN7O3+H].+
  • REFERENCES
    • 1. Taylor, E. C.; Harrington, P. M.; Schin, C. Heterocycles, 1989, 28, 1169, incorporated herein by reference
    • 2. Widsheis et al, Synthesis, 1994, 87-92, incorporated herein by reference.
    Sodium Channel Blocking Activity
  • The compounds shown in the Tables below were tested for potency in canine bronchial epithelia using the in vitro assay described above. Amiloride was also tested in this assay as a positive control. The results for the compounds of the present invention are reported as fold-enhancement values relative to amiloride.
  • Example 28
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00048
    Position Fold Enhancement
    n of R R Over Amiloride
    2 4 NH2 12.7
  • Example 29
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00049
    Fold Enhancement
    R Over Amiloride
    H 124
    Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00050
    36
    H3CxCH3* 91
    * = the R groups are bonded together via —C(CH3)2
  • Example 30
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00051
    Fold Enhancement
    n Over Amiloride
    1 87
    2 42
    4 28.7
  • Example 31
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00052
    Fold Enhancement
    R5 Over Amiloride
    40 65
    —O—SO3H 27.7
    —O-Glucuronide 11.2
    Na+ Salt
    —CH2OH 57
    —CO2CH3 26.5
  • Example 32 Effect of Compound (33) from Example 3 on MCC
  • These experiments were conducted with compound (33) from Example 3, and the vehicle as a control. The results are shown in FIGS. 1 (t=0 hours) and 2 (t=4 hours).
  • Methods
  • Animal Preparation: Adult ewes (ranging in weight from 25 to 35 kg) were restrained in an upright position in a specialized body harness adapted to a modified shopping cart. The animals' heads were immobilized and local anesthesia of the nasal passage was induced with 2% lidocaine. The animals were then nasally intubated with a 7.5 mm internal diameter endotracheal tube (ETT). The cuff of the ETT was placed just below the vocal cords and its position was verified with a flexible bronchoscope. After intubation the animals were allowed to equilibrate for approximately 20 minutes prior to initiating measurements of mucociliary clearance.
    Administration of Radio-aerosol: Aerosols of 99mTc-Human serum albumin (3.1 mg/ml; containing approximately 20 mCi) were generated using a Raindrop Nebulizer which produces a droplet with a median aerodynamic diameter of 3.6 μm. The nebulizer was connected to a dosimetry system consisting of a solenoid valve and a source of compressed air (20 psi). The output of the nebulizer was directed into a plastic T connector; one end of which was connected to the endotracheal tube, the other was connected to a piston respirator. The system was activated for one second at the onset of the respirator's inspiratory cycle. The respirator was set at a tidal volume of 500 mL, an inspiratory to expiratory ratio of 1:1, and at a rate of 20 breaths per minute to maximize the central airway deposition. The sheep breathed the radio-labeled aerosol for 5 minutes. A gamma camera was used to measure the clearance of 99mTc-Human serum albumin from the airways. The camera was positioned above the animal's back with the sheep in a natural upright position supported in a cart so that the field of image was perpendicular to the animal's spinal cord. External radio-labeled markers were placed on the sheep to ensure proper alignment under the gamma camera. All images were stored in a computer integrated with the gamma camera. A region of interest was traced over the image corresponding to the right lung of the sheep and the counts were recorded. The counts were corrected for decay and expressed as percentage of radioactivity present in the initial baseline image. The left lung was excluded from the analysis because its outlines are superimposed over the stomach and counts can be swallowed and enter the stomach as radio-labeled mucus.
    Treatment Protocol (Assessment of activity at t-zero): A baseline deposition image was obtained immediately after radio-aerosol administration. At time zero, after acquisition of the baseline image, vehicle control (distilled water), positive control (amiloride), or experimental compounds were aerosolized from a 4 ml volume using a Pari LC JetPlus nebulizer to free-breathing animals. The nebulizer was driven by compressed air with a flow of 8 liters per minute. The time to deliver the solution was 10 to 12 minutes. Animals were extubated immediately following delivery of the total dose in order to prevent false elevations in counts caused by aspiration of excess radio-tracer from the ETT. Serial images of the lung were obtained at 15-minute intervals during the first 2 hours after dosing and hourly for the next 6 hours after dosing for a total observation period of 8 hours, as shown in FIG. 1. A washout period of at least 7 days separated dosing sessions with different experimental agents.
    Treatment Protocol (Assessment of Activity at t-4 hours): The following variation of the standard protocol was used to assess the durability of response following a single exposure to vehicle control (distilled water), positive control compounds (amiloride or benzamil), or investigational agents. At time zero, vehicle control (distilled water), positive control (amiloride), or investigational compounds were aerosolized from a 4 ml volume using a Pari LC JetPlus nebulizer to free-breathing animals. The nebulizer was driven by compressed air with a flow of 8 liters per minute. The time to deliver the solution was 10 to 12 minutes. Animals were restrained in an upright position in a specialized body harness for 4 hours. At the end of the 4-hour period animals received a single dose of aerosolized 99mTc-Human serum albumin (3.1 mg/ml; containing approximately 20 mCi) from a Raindrop Nebulizer. Animals were extubated immediately following delivery of the total dose of radio-tracer. A baseline deposition image was obtained immediately after radio-aerosol administration. Serial images of the lung were obtained at 15-minute intervals during the first 2 hours after administration of the radio-tracer (representing hours 4 through 6 after drug administration) and hourly for the next 2 hours after dosing for a total observation period of 4 hours, as shown in FIG. 2. A washout period of at least 7 days separated dosing sessions with different experimental agents.
    Statistics: Data were analyzed using SYSTAT for Windows, version 5. Data were analyzed using a two-way repeated ANOVA (to assess overall effects), followed by a paried t-test to identify differences between specific pairs. Significance was accepted when P was less than or equal to 0.05. Slope values (calculated from data collected during the initial 45 minutes after dosing in the t-zero assessment) for mean MCC curves were calculated using linear least square regression to assess differences in the initial rates during the rapid clearance phase.
  • Example 33 Synthesis of N-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)-N′-{4-[4-(2-guanidinoethoxy)-phenyl]butyl}guanidine dihydrochloride (9518)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00053
  • {4-[4-(2-tert-Butoxycarbonylaminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl}carbamic acid benzyl ester (1)
  • Diisopropylazodicarboxylate (132 mL) was added dropwise over 45 minutes to a stirring mixture of [4-(4-hydroxyphenyl)butyl]carbamic acid benzyl ester (50 g, 0.167 mol), (2-hydroxyethyl)carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (103.4 mL, 0.668 mol), and THF (150 mL) with ice-methanol bath cooling from 15 to 35° C. When the exothermic reaction ceased, the cooling bath was removed, and the reaction was allowed to stir at room temperature overnight. The solvent was evaporated at reduced pressure, and the residue was applied to a 1 kg column of silica gel and eluted with methylene chloride. The chromatography was repeated twice. The residue after evaporation was washed with hexanes (1.5 L), and the resulting solid was re-crystallized from a mixture of hexanes and methylene chloride (4:1, 1 L) to afford 54 g (73%) of the pure product as a white solid. A second crop yielded an additional 10 g (13%) of the product. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.45 (s, 9H), 1.56 (m, 4H), 2.56 (t, 2H), 3.20 (m, 2H), 3.50 (m, 2H), 3.98 (t, 2H), 4.75 (br s, 1H), 5.00 (br s, 1H), 5.09 (s, 2H), 6.80 (d, 2H), 7.06 (d, 2H), 7.34 (m, 5H).
  • {2-[4-(4-Aminobutyl)phenoxy]ethyl}carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (2)
  • {4-[4-(2-tert-Butoxycarbonylaminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl}carbamic acid benzyl ester 1 (2.5 g, 5.60 mmol), ethanol (20 mL), and 10% palladium on carbon (1 g), were subject to one atmosphere of hydrogen for 4 h, and then allowed to stand overnight. After stirring under nitrogen purge, the catalyst was removed by filtering the reaction mixture through Celite and rinsing with methylene chloride. Evaporation followed by 2 h under high vacuum afforded the product (1.7 g, 98%) as an oil. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.45 (s, 9H), 1.47 (m, 2H), 1.61 (m, 2H), 1.75 (br s, 2H), 2.56 (t, 2H), 2.71 (t, 2H), 3.51 (m, 2H), 3.99 (t, 2H), 5.07 (br s, 1H), 6.80 (d, 2H), 7.08 (d, 2H).
  • [2-(4-{4-[N′-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidino]butyl}phenoxy)ethyl]-carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (3)
  • {2-[4-(4-Aminobutyl)phenoxy]ethyl}carbamic acid tert-butyl ester 2 (1.7 g, 5.5 mmol), 1-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)-2-methylisothiourea hydriodide (2.6 g, 6.6 mmol), and triethylamine (3.1 mL) were combined in THF (18 mL). The reaction was stirred at reflux under argon for 1.5 h. The product mixture was allowed to cool, and the solvent was evaporated. Chromatography (silica gel, methylene chloride/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide, 100:10:1) afforded 2.65 g (92%) of the pure product as a yellow foamy solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.44 (s, 9H), 1.62 (m, 2H), 1.61 (m, 2H), 1.75 (br s, 2H), 2.56 (t, 2H), 2.71 (t, 2H), 3.51 (m, 2H), 3.99 (t, 2H), 5.07 (br s, 1H), 6.80 (d, 2H), 7.08 (d, 2H).
  • N-{4-[4-(2-Aminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl}-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)-guanidine (4, 9308)
  • [2-(4-{4-[N′-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidino]butyl}phenoxy)ethyl]-carbamic acid tert-butyl ester 3 (2.63 g, 5.0 mmol) was dissolved in methanol (25 mL). 12N HCl (30 mL) was added in 10 ml portions. After stirring for 1 h, the reaction was complete by TLC (silica gel, methylene chloride/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide, 100:10:1). The solvent was evaporated and methanol (300 mL) was added and, this process was repeated. The residue was placed under high vacuum overnight to afford the product (2.65 g, 99%) as a yellow solid, which was used without further manipulation. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.58 (m, 4H), 2.57 (m, 2H), 3.16 (m, 2H), 3.37 (m, 2H), 4.18 (t, 2H), 6.91 (d, 2H), 7.15 (d, 2H), 7.45 (m, 4H), 8.45 (br s, 3H), 9.03 (br s, 2H), 9.46 (t, 1H), 10.63 (s, 1H).
  • N-(4-{4-[2-(N′,N′-Di-tert-butoxycarbonylguanidino)ethoxy]phenyl}butyl)-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloro-pyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine (5)
  • Triethylamine (1.4 mL, 10 mmole) was dripped, via a syringe, into a stirring solution of N-{4-[4-(2-aminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl}-N-(3,5-diamino-6-chloro-pyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine 4 (500 mg, 0.943 mmole) in methanol (3 mL). To this stirring solution was added 1,3-diBoc-2-(trifluoromethanesulfonyl)guanidine (Goodman's Reagent) (406 mg, 1.04 mmole), and this was allowed to stir at room temperature. After 2 h, TLC indicated the absence of Goodman's reagent. An additional 40 mg of the Goodman's reagent was added, and the reaction was stirred for additional 1 h. After evaporating at below 35° C., the crude product was chromatographed (silica gel, methylene chloride/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide, 100:10:1) to obtain the pure product as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.49 (s, 9H), 1.51 (s, 9H), 1.67 (m, 4H), 2.58 (m, 2H), 3.22 (m, 2H), 3.82 (q, 2H), 4.05 (t, 2H), 5.22 (br s, 1H), 6.84 (d, 2H), 7.06 (d, 2H), 8.73 (t, 1H), 11.47 (br s, 1H).
  • N-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)-N′-{4-[4-(2-guanidinoethoxy)phenyl]butyl}-guanidine dihydrochloride (6)
  • 12N HCl (15 mL) was added dropwise to an ice cooled solution of N-(4-{4-[2-(N′,N″-di-tert-butoxycarbonylguanidino)ethoxy]phenyl}butyl)-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)-guanidine 5 (370 mg, 0.56 mmole) in methanol (15 mL) over 1 min. After the addition, the cooling bath was removed, and the reaction was allowed to stir for 30 min. TLC (silica gel, methylene chloride/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide, 3:3:1) indicated slow reaction progression. An additional 15 mL of 12N HCl was added dropwise at room temperature, and after 2 h, TLC indicated reaction completion. The solvent was evaporated and methanol (100 mL) was added and then evaporated below 30° C., this process was repeated a further three times and then the residue was placed under vacuum at 40° C. for 2 days to afford 300 mg (96%) of the pure product as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.57 (m, 4H), 2.56 (m, 2H), 3.52 (m, 2H), 4.02 (t, 2H), 4.60 (br s, 2H), 6.88 (d, 2H), 7.14 (d, 2H), 7.41 (m, 8H), 7.91 (t, 1H), 8.93 (m, 2H), 9.33 (t, 1H), 10.55 (s, 1H). mp 223-230. m/z (ESI)=463 [C19H27ClN10O2+H]+.
  • Example 34 N-[4-(4-{2-[bis-((2S,3R)-2,3,4-trihydroxybutyl)amino]ethoxy}phenyl)butyl]-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine dihydrochloride (10833)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00054
  • Method A: via the reaction of {4-[4-(2-aminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl}carbamic acid benzyl ester 7 with D-(−)-erythrose.
  • {4-[4-(2-Aminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl}carbamic acid benzyl ester hydrochloride (7)
  • {4-[4-(2-tert-Butoxycarbonylaminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl}carbamic acid benzyl ester 1 (11.0 g, 24.9 mmol) was dissolved in methanol (110 mL) and THF (20 mL). 12N Hydrochloric acid (40 mL) was added dropwise, and the reaction was allowed to stir. After 1.5 h, ether (200 mL) was added, and the reaction was suction filtered to collect a white solid. The solid was washed with ether, air dried, and dried under vacuum. This afforded 7.6 g, (82%) of 7 as a white solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.39 (br s, 11H), 1.52 (m, 2H),
  • 4-[N,N-bis-((2S,3R)-2,3,4-trihydroxybutyl)-2-aminoethoxy]phenylbutylamine (9)
  • Acetic acid (0.18 mL, 3.08 mmol) and D-(−)-erythrose (0.74 g, 6.16 mmol) were sequentially added into a suspension of {4-[4-(2-aminoethoxy)phenyl]-butyl}carbamic acid benzyl ester hydrochloride 7 (0.58 g, 1.54 mmol) in methanol (20 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred for 20 minutes at room temperature and under nitrogen atmosphere; then sodium cyanoborohydride (0.39 g, 6.16 mmol) was added at −78° C. The reaction was allowed to warm up to room temperature. After overnight stirring, the solvent was evaporated and the residue was purified by Flash™ (BIOTAGE, Inc) (90 g silica gel cartridge 40M, 5:1:0.1 chloroform/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) to provide 8 (0.61 g, 72%) as a white solid. m/z (APCI)=551 [C28H42N2O9+H]+.
  • The compound 8 (0.30 g, 0.55 mmol) was dissolved in methanol (30 mL) and stirred with 10% palladium on carbon (0.24 g. wet) for 4 h at room temperature and atmospheric pressure of hydrogen. The mixture was then filtered through a silica gel pad; the solvent was evaporated to provide 9 (0.21 g, 92%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.55 (m, 2H), 1.66 (m, 2H) 2.58 (m, 2H), 2.70 (m, 4H), 2.92 (m, 2H), 2.96 (m, 2H), 3.05 (m, 2H), 3.42 (m, 2H), 3.55 (m, 2H), 3.62 (m, 2H), 3.70 (m, 2H), 4.10 (m, 2H), 6.86 (d, 2H), 7.08 (d, 2H).
  • N-[4-(4-{2-[bis-((2S,3R)-2,3,4-trihydroxybutyl)amino]ethoxy}phenyl)butyl]-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine dihydrochloride (10)
  • 1-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl)-2-methylisothiourea hydriodide (0.196 g, 0.5 mmol) and triethylamine (0.077 mL, 0.55 mmol) were sequentially added into a suspension of 9 (0.21 g, 0.5 mmol) in 10 mL of ethanol. The reaction mixture was stirred at 65° C. for 3 h; the solvent was then evaporated. The free base of the target compound 10 (0.166 g, 52%) was purified by Flash™ (BIOTAGE, Inc) (90 g silica gel cartridge 40M, 3:1:0.3 chloroform/ethanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) as a yellow solid. It was then treated with 3% HCl (2 mL). The precipitate was collected by filtration, washed with methylene chloride (4×5 mL), then taken into water (2 mL) and freeze-dried overnight to provide 152 mg (44%) of 10 as a yellow powder. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.70 (br.s, 4H), 2.64 (m, 2H), 3.28 (m, 2H), 3.32 (br.s, 2H), 3.49 (m, 2H), 3.55-3.80 (m, 8H), 3.87 (m, 2H), 4.05 (m, 2H), 4.35 (m, 2H), 6.95 (d, 2H), 7.15 (d, 2H). m/z (APCI)=629 [C26H41ClN8O8+H]+, [α]D 25=−12.6° (c=1.03, MeOH).
    Method B: via the reaction of N-{4-[4-(2-aminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl}-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine 4 with D-(−)-erythrose.
    The compound 4 (0.2 g, 0.48 mmol) was suspended in 7 mL of methanol and D-(−)-erythrose (0.17 g, 1.4 mmol) dissolved in 0.9 mL of methanol was added. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 30 min. After this time 25 μL of acetic acid was added to give a clear solution. The reaction mixture was cooled to −78° C. and sodium cyanoborohydride (0.084 g, 1.4 mmol) was added. The reaction was stirred at −78° C. for 2 h and at room temperature for 3 d. After this time the solvent was removed under reduced pressure and 15 mL of water was added to the oily residue. The oil transformed into a yellow solid after 18 h in refrigerator. The solid was isolated by centrifugation, washed with water and dissolved in MeOH containing 0.05 mL of TFA. Silica gel (approx. 20 mL) was added and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The impregnated silica gel was submitted for purification using Flash™ (Biotage Inc., 90 g silica gel cartridge, eluent: chloroform/methanol/ammonium hydroxide=4:1:0.2). The resulting yellow solid was dissolved in 10 mL of 5% HCl and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure to give compound 10 (100 mg, 30%) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.70 (br s, 4H), 2,64 (m, 2H), 3.29-3.70 (m, 20H), 4.07 (m, 2H) 4.37 (br s, 2H), 6.95 (d, 2H), 7.15 (d, 2H). m/z (APCI)=629 [C26H41ClN8O8+H]+.
    Methods C: via 2,4-ethylidene-D-erythrose
    Method C.1—precursor (11) constructed directly from pre-assembled amine (4)
  • N-[4-(4-{2-[Bis-((2R,4S,5R)-5-hydroxy-2-methyl[1,3]dioxan-4-ylmethyl)amino]-ethoxy}phenyl)butyl]-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)-guanidine (11)
  • The free base 4 (0.15 g, 0.35 mmol) was suspended in 6 mL of methanol. 2,4-Ethylidene-D-erythrose1 (0.15 g, 1.05 mmol) in 2 mL of methanol was added, followed by the addition of 20 μL (0.35 mmol) of acetic acid. The mixture was stirred at room temperature until a clear solution was formed (approx. 10 min). The reaction solution was cooled to −78° C. and sodium cyanoborohydride (0.07 g, 1.05 mmol) was added. The reaction mixture was stirred at −78° C. for 2 h and at room temperature for 2 d. After this time, the solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue purified by Flash™ (Biotage Inc., 90 g silica gel cartridge eluent: chloroform/methanol/ammonium hydroxide=10:1:0.1) to give 0.17 g (70%) of 11 as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.21 (m, 6H), 1.65 (br s., 4H), 2.59 (m, 2H), 2.84 (m, 2H), 2.92-3.60 (m, 12H), 4.03 (m, 4H), 6.84 (d, 2H), 7.10 (d, 2H). m/z (APCI)=681 [C30H45ClN8O8+H]+.
    Method C.2—precursor (11) constructed after side chain assembly
  • 4-(4-{2-[Bis-((2R,4S,5R)-5-hydroxy-2-methyl[1,3]dioxan-4-ylmethyl)amino]ethoxy}phenyl)-butylcarbamic acid benzyl ester (12)
  • The compound 7 (0.5 g, 1.32 mmol) was suspended in 8 mL of methanol. 2,4-Ethylidene-D-erythrose (0.6 g, 4.1 mmol) in 2 mL of methanol was added, followed by the addition of 80 μL (1.32 mmol) of acetic acid. The mixture was stirred at room temperature until a clear solution was formed (approx. 10 min). The reaction solution was cooled to −78° C. and sodium cyanoborohydride (0.260 g, 1.05 mmol) was added. The reaction mixture was stirred at −78° C. for 2 h and at room temperature for 18 h. After this time, the solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the target compound 12 (0.6 g, 80%) was isolated by Flash™ (Biotage Inc., 90 g silica gel cartridge, eluent: dichlromethane/methanol/ammonium hydroxide=17:1:0.1) as a clear oil. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.24 (m., 2H), 1.50 (m, 2H), 2,56 (m, 2H), 2.72 (m, 2H), 3.1 (m, 4H), 3.31-3.48 (m, 6H), 4.02 (m, 2H), 4.08 (m, 2H), 4.65 (m, 2H), 5.05 (s, 2H), 6.74 (d, 2H), 7.0.5 (d, 2H), 7.23 (m, 5H). m/z (APCI)=603 [C32H46ClN2O9+H]+.
  • 4-(4-{2-[Bis-((2R,4S,5R)-5-hydroxy-2-methyl[1,3] dioxan-4-ylmethyl)amino]ethoxy}phenyl)-butylamine (13)
  • The protected amine 12 was stirred at room temperature overnight in 25 mL of methanol with Pd/C (186 mg, 10% wet) under hydrogen (1 atm). After this time, the catalyst was filtered off and solvent removed under reduced pressure to give amine 13 (0.49 g, 93%) as a clear oil. The purity of 13 was confirmed by TLC on silica gel (eluent: chloroform/methanol/ammonium hydroxide=2.5:1:0.1).
  • N-[4-(4-{2-[Bis-((2R,4S,5R)-5-hydroxy-2-methyl[1,3]dioxan-4-ylmethyl)amino]ethoxy}-phenyl)butyl]-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)-guanidine (11)
  • 1-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl-2-methylisothiourea hydriodide (0.39 g, 1.0 mmol) was added to a solution of 13 (0.49 g, 1.07 mmol) in THF (8 mL) containing diisopropylethylamine (0.18 mL, 2 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at reflux for 2.5 h and at room temperature overnight. After this time, the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The brown residue was washed with ether (2×30 mL) and methylene chloride (2×10 mL). The residue was dissolved in a minimal volume of methanol (approx. 2 mL) and poured into water. The precipitate was collected, washed with water and dried overnight to give crude 11 (0.5 g) as a yellow solid. The compound 11 (0.4 g, 54%) was purified by flash chromatography on silica gel (eluent: chloroform/methanol/ammonium hydroxide=10:1:0.1) as a yellow solid. [α]D 25=−20.4° (c=1.0, MeOH).
  • N-[4-(4-{2-[bis-((2S,3R)-2,3,4-trihydroxybutyl)amino]ethoxy}phenyl)butyl]-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine dihydrochloride (10)
  • The compound II (0.18 g, 0.26 mmol) was dissolved in 15 mL of 10% HCl and the reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 18 h. After this time the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The resulting residue was dried overnight and purified by flash chromatography on silica gel (eluent: chloroform/methanol/ammonium hydroxide=3:1:0.3) to give 66 mg of a yellow solid. The solid was dissolved in 2.5 mL of 5% HCl and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in 1.5 mL of methanol and the methanol solution was poured into 2-propyl alcohol. The formed precipitate was collected, washed with methylene chloride and dried in vacuum. 34 mg (18%) of dihydrochloride 10 was obtained. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.71 (br s., 4H), 2,64 (m, 2H), 3.29-3.70 (m, 20H), 4.07 (m, 2H), 4.36 (br s., 2H), 6.96 (d, 2H), 7.16 (d, 2H). m/z (APCI)=629 [C26H41ClN8O8+H]+; [α]D 2=−12.6° (c=1.0, MeOH).
    Method D: via (2R,3S)-3,4-epoxybutan-1,2-diol
  • 4-(4-[(2-[Bis-((2S,3R)-2,3,4-trihydroxybutyl)amino]ethoxy]phenyl)butylamine (69)
  • A solution composed of {4-[4-(2-aminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl}carbamic acid tert-butyl ester 161 (0.21 g, 0.681 mmol) and (2R,3S)-3,4-epoxybutan-1,2-diol2 (68) (0.177 g, 1.702 mmol) in ethanol (5 mL) was heated at 70° C. overnight. It was then slowly cooled to room temperature and treated with concentrated hydrochloric acid (12N, 6 mL) at room temperature for 3 hours. The reaction mixture was concentrated under vacuum. The residue was taken into ethanol (3 mL) and the resulting solution was concentrated again under vacuum. The procedure was repeated two more times to ensure no aqueous solvent remained. The residue was chromatographed over silica gel, eluting with a mixture of concentrated ammonium hydroxide (0-10%), methanol (0-30%), and methylene chloride (100-60%), to afford 0.273 g (89%) of the product 69 as a colorless viscous oil. [α]D 25=−33.1° (c 1.0, MeOH). 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.49-1.61 (m, 4H), 2.53-2.73 (m, 5H), 2.90-3.04 (m, 4H), 3.52-3.73 (m, 17H), 4.07 (t, J=5.7 Hz, 2H), 6.84 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 2H), 7.07 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 2H). m/z (APCI)=417 [C20H36N2O7+H]+.
  • N-[4-(4-{2-[Bis-((2S,3R)-2,3,4-trihydroxybutyl)amino]ethoxy}phenyl)butyl]-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine dihydrochloride (70, ALB 10833)
  • Compound 69 (0.112 g, 0.269 mmol) was mixed with ethanol (5 mL). The mixture was heated at 65° C. for 15 min to achieve complete dissolution. To the clear solution were sequentially added triethylamine (23 μL, 0.161 mmol) and 1-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl)-2-methylisothiourea hydriodide (0.105 g, 0.269 mmol). The mixture was heated at 65° C. for an additional 2 hours. It was, while still warm, slowly added into methyl tert-butyl ether (MTBE, 25 mL) cooled by an ice bath. A light yellow precipitation immediately formed upon the addition of the reaction mixture. The suspension was allowed to warm up to room temperature by removing the ice bath, and the stirring was continued for one more hour. The solid was vacuum filtered, washed with MTBE (3×5 mL), and tried under vacuum for 4 hours. The dry material (0.155 g) was then suspended in ethanol (3 mL), and treated with concentrated HCl (1 mL). Water (3 mL) was added to completely dissolve the solid. The resulting solution was concentrated to dryness under vacuum. The residue was taken into methanol (2 mL). The resultant methanolic solution was added into 2-propyl alcohol (15 mL) at room temperature. The resulting light yellow suspension was stirred at room temperature overnight. The solid was then vacuum filtered, washed with 2-propyl alcohol (3×3 mL), and dried under vacuum. 0.093 g (49%) of the compound 70 was obtained as a light yellow solid. [α]D 25=−13.9° (c 1.0, MeOH). 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.46-1.68 (m, 4H), 2.50-2.57 (m, 2H), 3.26-3.70 (m, 15H), 3.88-4.98 (m, 2H), 4.35-4.72 (m, 2H), 4.98-5.10 (br s, 2H), 5.50-6.70 (br s, 2H), 6.93 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H), 7.16 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H), 7.45 (br s, 2H), 7.84-8.06 (br s, 1H), 8.61 (br s, 1H), 8.81 (br s, 1H), 8.94 (br s, 1H), 9.25 (br s, 1H), 10.51 (br s, 1H). m/z (APCI)=629 [C26H41ClN8O8+H]+.
  • Example 35 N-[4-(4-{2-[bis-((2R,3S)-2,3,4-trihydroxybutyl)amino]ethoxy}phenyl)-butyl]-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine dihydrochloride (14143, the enantiomer of 10833)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00055
  • (2-Bromoethyl)carbamic acid benzyl ester (14)
  • Benzyl chloroformate (26 mL, 0.176 mole) was added in one portion to a stirring mixture of bromoethylamine hydrobromide (44 g, 0.21 mole), triethylamine (64 mL, 0.46 mole), and methylene chloride (1 L) at below −40° C. After the addition, the cooling bath was removed, and the reaction was allowed to stir for 3 h. The mixture was transferred to a 2 L separatory funnel, and sequentially washed with water (2×500 mL), 2N HCl (250 mL), and water (500 mL). The resulting solution was suction filtered through a 100 g pad of silica gel and washed with methylene chloride. Evaporation of the solvents afforded the product 14 (40 g, 89%) as an oil. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 3.46 (t, 2H), 3.60 (q, 2H), 5.11 (s, 2H), 5.20 (br s, 1H), 7.35 (m, 5H).
  • {4-[4-(2-Benzyloxycarbonylaminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl}carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (15)
  • [4-(4-Hydroxyphenyl)butyl]carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (38 g, 0.143 mole), cesium carbonate (84 g, 0.257 mole), and (2-bromoethyl)carbamic acid benzyl ester 14 (59 g, 0.23 mole) were combined in DMF (200 ml). The mixture was mechanically stirred under nitrogen at 63° C. for 5.5 h, and allowed to stand at room temperature overnight. An additional amount of (2-bromoethyl)carbamic acid benzyl ester 14 (5 g, 0.019 mole) and cesium carbonate (7.1 g, 0.21 mole) were added, and the reaction was further stirred at 65° C. for 1 h. Toluene was then added, and the stirring mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature. The mixture was suction filtered through a medium sintered glass buchner funnel and washed with toluene. The solvents were removed under vacuum at 75° C. The remaining oil was washed with hexanes (2×400 mL), then dissolved in ether (500 ml) and washed with a mixture of water and brine (10:1, 4×100 mL). The remaining solution was suction filtered through a 30 g pad of silica gel and the solvent evaporated. The residue was washed with hexanes (3×400 ml), and then placed under vacuum for 2 h to afford 61.8 g of the product 15 which was used without further purification. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.45 (s, 9H), 1.54 (m, 4H), 2.56 (t, 2H), 3.20 (m, 2H), 3.50 (m, 2H), 3.98 (t, 2H), 4.75 (br s, 1H), 5.00 (br s, 1H), 5.09 (s, 2H), 6.80 (d, 2H), 7.06 (d, 2H), 7.34 (m, 5H).
  • {4-[4-(2-Aminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl}carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (16)
  • {4-[4-(2-Benzyloxycarbonylaminoethoxy)phenyl]butyl}carbamic acid tert-butyl ester 15 (61.8 g) was stirred in ethanol (500 ml) with 10% palladium on carbon (6 g, wet), under one atmosphere of hydrogen. After stirring for more than 6 h, TLC (silica gel, methylene chloride/THF, 20:1) indicated reaction completion. The complete reaction was flushed with nitrogen, and suction filtered through a pad of Celite, and the pad washed with methylene chloride. The residue (41 g) after evaporation of the methylene chloride was applied to an 800 g pad of silica gel, and sequentially eluted with a mixture of THF and methylene chloride (1.4 L, 2:1), and a mixture of methylene chloride, methanol, and concentrated ammonium:hydroxide (30:10:1, 2 L). The fraction containing the product was collected. Evaporation afforded the pure product 16 (32.8 g, 74% over 2 steps). 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.44 (s, 9H), 1.50 (br s, 2H), 1.55 (m, 4H), 2.56 (t, 2H), 3.12 (m, 2H), 3.50 (m, 2H), 3.98 (t, 2H), 4.75 (br s, 1H), 5.00 (br s, 1H), 5.09 (s, 2H), 6.80 (d, 2H), 7.06 (d, 2H), 7.34 (m, 5H).
  • [4-(4-{2-[Bis-((2R,3S)-2,3,4-trihydroxybutyl)amino]ethoxy}phenyl)butyl]carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (18)
  • A solution composed of the compound 16 (0.4 g, 1.297 mmol) and (2S,3R)-3,4-epoxybutan-1,2-diol2 (17) (0.405 g, 3.891 mmol) in ethanol (6 mL) was heated at 60° C. overnight. It was then concentrated under vacuum. The residue was loaded onto silica gel, and eluted by a mixture of concentrated ammonium hydroxide (0-3%), methanol (0-30%), and methylene chloride (100-67%) to afford 0.592 g (88%) of the product 18 as a colorless viscous oil. [α]D 25=+19.9° (c 0.84, MeOH). 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD): δ 1.32-1.67 (m, 13H), 2.54 (t, J=7.1 Hz, 2H), 2.72-2.79 (m, 2H), 2.94 (dd, J=13.2 Hz, 3.3 Hz, 2H), 3.02-3.09 (m, 2H), 3.51-3.55 (m, 4H), 3.59 (d, J=3.0 Hz, 2H), 3.67-3.74 (m, 4H), 4.08 (t, J=5.6 Hz, 2H), 4.63 (br, 1H), 6.86 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 2H), 7.07 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 2H). m/z (APCI)=517 [C25H44N2O9+H]+.
  • 4-(4-{2-[Bis-((2R,3S)-2,3,4-trihydroxybutyl)amino]ethoxy}phenyl)butylamine (19)
  • To a solution containing the compound 18 (0.502 g, 0.972 mmol) in ethanol (10 mL) was slowly added concentrated hydrochloric acid (12N, 2 mL). The clear solution was stirred at room temperature for 4 hours. The reaction mixture was concentrated under vacuum. The residue was taken into ethanol (3 mL) and the resulting solution was concentrated again under vacuum. The procedure was repeated two more times to ensure no aqueous solvent remained. The residue was chromatographed over silica gel, eluting with a mixture of concentrated ammonium hydroxide (0-10%), methane (0-30%), and methylene chloride (100-60%), to afford 0.396 g (98%) of the product 19 as a low melting white solid. [α]D 25=+24.2° (c 0.265, MeOH). 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 1.32-1.52 (m, 4H), 2.46-2.55 (m, 4H), 2.74-2.79 (m, 2H), 2.84-2.96 (m, 2H), 3.31-3.99 (m, 16H), 4.01 (t, J=5.9 Hz, 2H), 6.40 (br s, 2H), 6.82 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 7.09 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H). m/z (APCI)=417 [C20H36N2O7+H]+.
  • N-[4-(4-{2-[Bis-((2R,3S)-2,3,4-trihydroxybutyl)amino]ethoxy}phenyl)butyl]-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine (20, ALB 14143)
  • The compound 19 (0.15 g, 0.331 mmol) was mixed with ethanol (5 mL). The mixture was heated at 65° C. for 15 min to achieve complete dissolution. To the clear solution were sequentially added di-isopropylethylamine (0.26 mL, 1.505 mmol) and 1-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl)-2-methylisothiourea hydriodide (0.117 g, 0.301 mmol). The mixture was heated at 65° C. for an additional 2 hours, and subsequently concentrated under vacuum. The residue was chromatographed over silica gel, eluting with a mixture of concentrated ammonium hydroxide (1-7%), methanol (10-30%), and methylene chloride (89-63%), to afford 0.152 g (80%) of the free base of 20 as a yellow solid. mp 78-80° C. (decomposed), [α]D 25=+19.3° (c 1.075, MeOH). 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 1.46-1.68 (m, 4H), 2.48-2.62 (m, 2H), 2.74-2.95 (m, 4H), 3.08-3.19 (m, 2H), 3.26-3.70 (m, 12H), 4.03 (t, J=5.9 Hz, 2H), 4.35-4.72 (m, 6H), 6.60-6.74 (br s, 3H), 6.83 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H), 7.11 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H), 9.05 (br s, 2H). m/z (APCI)=629 [C26H41ClN8O8+H]+.
    A sample of the free base of the compound 20 (0.2 g) was treated with 2N HCl (8 mL). The solution was concentrated to dryness under vacuum. The residue was taken into methanol (2 mL). The resultant methanolic solution was added into 2-propyl alcohol (15 mL) at room temperature, resulting in a light yellow suspension. The solid was vacuum filtered, washed with 2-propyl alcohol (3×3 mL), and dried under vacuum. 0.21 g (94%) of the compound 20 was obtained as a light yellow solid. mp 93-96° C. (decomposed); [α]D 25=+9.06° (c 1.17, MeOH). 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 1.46-1.68 (m, 4H), 2.48-2.62 (m, 2H), 3.26-3.70 (m, 17H), 4.03 (t, J=5.9 Hz, 2H), 4.35-4.72 (m, 2H), 4.98-5.10 (m 2H), 5.50-6.70 (br s, 2H), 6.94 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H), 7.14 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H), 7.40 (br s, 1H), 7.42-7.67 (br s, 1H), 8.68-8.89 (br s, 2H), 9.31 (br s, 1H), 10.53 (br s, 1H). m/z (APCI)=629 [C26H41ClN8O8+H]+.
  • Example 36 N-[4-(4-{2-[(2S,3R)-2,3,4-trihydroxybutylamino]ethoxy}phenyl)butyl]-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine dihydrochloride (10733)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00056
  • N-[4-(4-{2-[(2S,3R)-2,3,4-trihydroxybutylamino]ethoxy}phenyl)butyl]-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine dihydrochloride (22)
  • The free base 4 (0.3 g, 0.71 mmol) was suspended in 12 mL of methanol and 0.09 mL (1.4 mmol) of AcOH was added. The mixture was stirred at room temperature until a clear solution was formed. 2,4-Ethylidene-D-erythrose (0.13 g, 0.92 mmol) was then added. The reaction solution was cooled to −78° C. and sodium cyanoborohydride (0.06 g, 0.92 mmol) was added. The reaction mixture was stirred at −78° C. for 2 h and then at room temperature for 18 h. After this time the solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue purified by Flash™ (Biotage Inc., 90 g silica gel cartridge eluent: chloroform/methanol/ammonium hydroxide=15:1:0.1) to give 0.26 g (66%) of 21 as a yellow solid. A sample of the compound 21 (0.2 g, 0.36 mmol) was then dissolved in methanol (15 mL) and 300 mg of acidic resin (Dowex 50 WX8-200) was added. The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 2 d. After this time, the resin was filtered off and washed with methanol. Then the resin was washed with a 1:1 mixture of MeOH/NH4OH, (2×20 mL) and filtered off. The supernatants were combined and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica gel (eluent: chloroform/methanol/ammonium hydroxide=3:1:0.3). The obtained compound was dried overnight. After this time, the dry residue was dissolved in 5% HCl. Solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the formed yellow solid was dried overnight to give compound 22 (0.12 g, 55%). 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.68 (br s., 4H), 2.64 (m, 2H), 3.15-3.75 (m, 11H), 3.95 (m, 1H), 6.94 (d, 2H), 7.18 (d, 2H), 9.23 (m, 1H). m/z (APCI)=525 [C22H33ClN8O5+H]+.
  • Example 37 N-[4-(4-{2-[bis-((2R,3S,4R)-2,3,4,5-tetrahydroxypentyl)amino]ethoxy}-phenyl)butyl]-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine dihydrochloride (4330)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00057
  • N-[4-(4-{2-[bis-((2R,3S,4R)-2,3,4,5-tetrahydroxypentyl)amino]ethoxy}-phenyl)butyl]-N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidine dihydrochloride (23)
  • D-(+)-xylose (0.35 g, 2.6 mmol) was added to a solution of hydrochloride 4 (0.3 g, 0.65 mmol) in methanol (20 mL) and the mixture was stirred for 20 min at room temperature. Then the solution was cooled to −78° C. and sodium cyanoborohydride (0.17 g, 2.6 mmol) was added. The reaction mixture was stirred at −78° C. for 2 h and at room temperature for 4 d. After this time, the solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was washed with water. The formed yellow solid was isolated and dried under vacuum. Then the residue was re-dissolved in 5% HCl and the solvent was removed at reduced pressure. The obtained compound was dissolved in water containg 0.1% TFA and purified by preparative HPLC (C 18 Luna column from Phenomenex 250×21.2 mm, 5μ, isocratic method, water/acetonitrile=80%:20%). The fractions containing the target compound were combined and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in 5% HCl and solvent was removed under reduced pressure (twice). The resulting yellow powder was dissolved in water and the solution was lyophylized to give 34 mg (7%) of compound 23 as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.64 (br s., 4H), 2,62 (m, 2H), 3.30 (m, 4H), 3.35-3.70 (m, 13H), 4.23 (m, 2H), 4.47 (m, 2H), 6.95 (d, 2H), 7.15 (d, 2H). m/z (APCI)=689 [C28H45ClN8O10+H]+.[α]D 25=−16.1° (c=0.5, MeOH).
  • Example 38 4-{4-[N-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidino]butyl}-N-(2-hydroxyethyl)benzamide hydrochloride (11180)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00058
  • The synthesis of 4-(4-Carboxymethylphenyl)butylamine (24) was described in the previous previously provided experimental details (as compound 8).
  • 4-(4-tert-Butoxycarbonylaminobutyl)benzoic acid methyl ester (25)
  • Di-tert-butyl dicarbonate (1.64 g, 7.51 mmol) was added into the solution of 24 (1 g, 4.84 mmol) in anhydrous methylene chloride (50 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred overnight under an argon atmosphere at room temperature. Then the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was separated by Flash™ (BIOTAGE, Inc) (90 g silica gel cartridge 40M, 3:1 hexane/ethyl acetate) to provide 25 as a white solid (1.35 g, 91%). 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.42 (s, 9H), 1.52 (m, 2H), 1.64 (m, 2H), 2.69 (m, 2H), 3.13 (m, 2H), 3.90 (s, 3H), 4.57 (br s, 1H), 7.22 (d, 2H), 7.95 (d, 2H).
  • 4-(4-tert-butoxycarbonylaminobutyl)benzoic acid (26)
  • An aqueous (10 mL) solution of sodium hydroxide (0.53 g, 13.18 mmol) was added into the solution of 25 (1.35 g, 4.39 mmol) in THF (60 mL) and the resulting solution was stirred at room temperature for 48 h and at 60° C. for 14 h. Then the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. Water (20 mL) was added and pH was adjusted to 7 with HCl. The white solid precipitate was filtered off, washed with water and dried under vacuum. 1.22 g (95%) of white solid 26 was obtained. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.39 (br s, 11H), 1.52 (m, 2H), 1.64 (m, 2H), 2.92 (m, 2H), 6.84 (m, 1H), 7.28 (d, 2H), 7.85 (d, 2H).
  • {4-[4-(2-Hydroxyethylcarbamoyl)phenyl]butyl}carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (27)
  • 1,1′-Carbonyldiimidazole (0.6 g, 3.71 mmol) was added into the solution of 26 (0.91 g, 3.09 mmol) in THF (50 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight under argon atmosphere, then ethanolamine (0.28 mL, 4.64 mmol) was added. The stirring was continued for 24 h at room temperature and argon atmosphere. The solvent was evaporated and the residue was purified by Flash™ (BIOTAGE, Inc) (90 g silica gel cartridge 40M, 18:1:0.1 chloroform/ethanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide). 0.74 g (71%) of a white solid 27 was isolated. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.40 (s, 9H), 1.48 (m, 2H), 1.60 (m, 2H), 2.62 (m, 2H), 3.10 (m, 2H), 3.79 (m, 2H), 4.55 (br s, 1H), 6.74 (m, 1H), 7.18 (d, 2H), 7.66 (d, 2H).
  • 4-(4-Aminobutyl)-N-(2-hydroxyethyl)benzamide hydrochloride (28)
  • A solution of 27 (0.4 g, 1.19 mmol) was stirred at room temperature in a mixture of methanol/HCl (1:1, 40 mL). The reaction was finished in 2 h according to HPLC analysis. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure to provide 0.33 g (98%) 28 as a white solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.60 (m, 4H), 2.63 (m, 2H), 2.78 (m, 2H), 3.31 (m, 2H), 3.50 (m, 2H), 7.28 (d, 2H), 7.80 (d, 2H), 7.97 (br s, 2H), 8.46 (m, 1H).
  • 4-{4-[N-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidino]butyl}-N-(2-hydroxy-ethyl)benzamide hydrochloride (29)
  • 1-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl)-2-methylisothiourea hydriodide (0.48 g, 1.24 mmol) and triethylamine (0.7 mL, 4.74 mmol) were sequentially added into a solution of 28 (0.28 g, 1.19 mmol) in a mixture of THF/MeOH (4 mL, 1/1). The reaction mixture was stirred in the boiling solvent for 4 h, then at room temperature overnight. The solvent was evaporated. The free base of the target compound 29 (0.36 g, 62%) was purified by Flash™ (BIOTAGE, Inc) (90 g silica gel cartridge 40M, 12:1:0.1 chloroform/ethanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) as a yellow solid. 100 mg of the yellow solid was treated with 2 mL of 3% HCl. The precipitate was collected by filtration, washed with water (2×5 mL) and dried under vacuum to give 85 mg (79%) of 29 as a yellow powder. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.60 (m, 4H), 2.68 (m, 2H), 3.28 (m, 4H), 3.49 (m, 2H), 4.80 (m, 1H), 7.28 (d, 2H), 7.44 (br s, 2H), 7.82 (d, 2H), 8.45 (m, 1H). m/z (APCI)=449 [C19H25ClN8O3+H]+.
  • Example 39 2-{4-[N′-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidino]-4-butylphenoxy}acetamide hydrochloride (9714)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00059
  • [4-(4-Benzyloxycarbonylaminobutyl)phenoxy]acetic acid ethyl ester (47)
  • Sodium hydride (60% dispersion in mineral oil) (0.24 g, 10.05 mmol) was added to a cold (0° C.) solution of 4-(4-hydroxyphenyl)butylamine (2 g, 6.68 mmol) in THF (150 mL) under nitrogen atmosphere. The reaction mixture was allowed to warm up to room temperature over 0.5 h with stirring, then ethyl bromoacetate (0.96 mL, 8.02 mmol) and tetrabutylammonium iodide (0.25 g, 0.67 mmol) was sequentially added. The reaction was further stirred at room temperature overnight. Silica gel (25 mL) was added into the mixture and the solvent was evaporated. The impregnated silica gel was subjected to column chromatography purification (silica gel, 5:1 hexanes/ethyl acetate). 2.42 g (94%) of 47 was obtained as a white solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.30 (t, 3H), 1.57 (m, 4H), 2.58 (m, 2H), 3.20 (m, 2H), 4.28 (m, 2H), 4.58 (s, 2H), 4.74 (br s, 1H), 5.10 (br s, 2H), 6.82 (m, 2H), 7.08 (m, 2H), 7.38 (br s, 5H).
  • [4-(4-Aminobutyl)phenoxy]acetic acid ethyl ester (48)
  • A suspension of 47 (1.11 g, 2.88 mmol) and 10% palladium on carbon (0.40 g, wet) in methanol (50 mL) was stirred at room temperature for 2 h under atmospheric pressure of hydrogen. The mixture was then filtered through a silica gel pad. The solvent was evaporated to provide 48 (0.64 g, 88%) as a white solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.21 (m, 3H), 1.30-1.63 (m, 6H), 3.13 (m, 2H), 4.17 (m, 2H), 4.72 (br s, 2H), 6.84 (m, 2H), 7.10 (m, 2H).
  • (4-{4-[N′-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidino]butyl}phenoxy)acetic acid ethyl ester (49)
  • 1-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl)-2-methylisothiourea hydriodide (0.74 g, 1.9 mmol) and triethylamine (0.5 mL) were sequentially added into a solution of 48 (0.62 g, 2.47 mmol) in THF (10 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred in the boiling solvent for 4 h and at room temperature overnight. The solvent was evaporated and the residue was purified by column chromatography (silica gel, 6:1:0.1 chloroform/ethanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) to provide 49 (0.5 g, 57%) as a yellow solid. The purity of the product was confirmed by HPLC. m/z (APCI)=464 [C20H26ClN7O4+H]+.
  • 2-{4-[N′-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidino]-4-butylphenoxy}acetamide hydrochloride (50, 9714)
  • A solution of 49 (0.5 g, 1.08 mmol) in ammonia-saturated ethanol (100 mL) was stirred at room temperature overnight. The solvent was evaporated and the residue was purified by column chromatography (silica gel, 4:1:0.1 chloroform/ethanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide) to afford the free base of the product 50 as a yellow solid. It was then treated with 3% HCl. The solvent was evaporated. The resulting solid was washed with water (2×5 mL), and then dried in vacuum to provide 50 (0.25 g, 49%) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.57 (br s, 4H), 2.51 (m, 2H), 3.33 (m, 2H), 4.48 (s, 2H), 6.87 (d, 2H), 7.13 (d, 2H), 7.37-7.60 (m, 4H), 8.88 (br s, 11H), 8.99 (br s, 1H), 9.32 (m, 1H), 10.56 (s, 11H). m/z (APCI)=435.3 [C18H23ClN8O3+H]+.
  • Example 40 4-{4-[N′-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidino]butyl}benzamidine (11157)
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00060
  • [4-(4-Cyanophenyl)but-3-ynyl]carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (56)
  • But-3-ynylcarbamic acid tert-butyl ester (3.66 g, 22 mmol) was added dropwise to an ice cooled, stirring, argon purged mixture of 4-iodobenzonitrile (4.5 g, 19.6 mmol), dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(II) (0.69 g, 0.98 mmol), copper (I) iodide (0.19 g, 0.98 mmol), triethylamine (11 mL, 78.4 mmol), and THF (24 mL). After stirring for 10 min, the ice bath was removed, and the reaction was allowed to stir for an additional 2 h. The reaction mixture was passed through a pad of silica gel with methylene chloride/ethyl acetate (5:1) as eluant. After evaporating the solvent, the crude product was chromatographed with methylene chloride/ethyl acetate (20:1) as eluant. Evaporation of the solvent, followed by placement under vacuum for 1 h, afforded the pure product 56 (5.2 g, 99%) as an oil. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.46 (s, 9H), 2.64 (t, 2H), 3.37 (m, 2H), 4.85 (br s, 1H), 7.47 (d, 2H), 7.58 (d, 2H).
  • [4-(4-Cyanophenyl)butyl]carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (57)
  • A suspension of [4-(4-cyanophenyl)but-3-ynyl]carbamic acid tert-butyl ester 56 (5.2 g, 19.2 mmol) and 10% palladium on carbon (2.5 g, wet) in ethanol/THF (30 mL, 1:1) was stirred overnight under 1 atmosphere of hydrogen. After purging with nitrogen, the reaction mixture was suction filtered through a pad of Celite. The solvent was removed from the filtrate by evaporation. The residue was chromatographed on silica gel, eluting with methylene chloride/ethyl acetate (30:1), to afford the pure product 57 (4.6 g, 87%) as an oil. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.44 (s, 9H), 1.51 (m, 2H), 1.65 (m, 2H), 2.69 (t, 2H), 3.14 (m, 2H), 4.52 (br s, 1H), 7.27 (d, 2H), 7.56 (d, 2H).
  • [4-(4-Thiocarbamoylphenyl)butyl]carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (58)
  • Nitrogen was bubbled through a stirring solution of [4-(4-cyanophenyl)butyl]carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (57) (4.5 g, 16.4 mmol), pyridine (60 mL), and triethylamine (60 mL) for 10 min. Hydrogen sulfide was slowly bubbled through this stirring solution for 10 min. The reaction was sealed, and allowed to stir overnight. The reaction mixture was then purged with nitrogen, transferred to a separatory funnel with ethyl acetate (500 mL), and sequentially washed with water (3×100 mL), saturated aqueous solution of potassium hydrogen sulfate (3×100 mL), water (2×50 mL), and brine (2×50 mL). The solution was dried over sodium sulfate. The solid was filtered, and the filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting solid was re-crystallized from hexanes/ethyl acetate (10:1), and placed under vacuum for 2 h to afford the pure product 58 (4.8 g, 95%) as a yellow crystalline solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.43 (s, 9H), 1.49 (m, 2H), 1.63 (m, 2H), 2.65 (t, 2H), 3.11 (m, 2H), 4.57 (br s, 1H), 7.19 (d, 2H), 7.42 (br s, 1H), 7.81 (d, 2H).
  • [4-(4-Carbamimidoylphenyl)butyl]carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (59)
  • [4-(4-Thiocarbamoylphenyl)butyl]carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (58) (500 mg, 1.6 mmol) and iodomethane (4 mL, 64 mmol) were combined in methylene chloride (8 mL). The solution was stirred at reflux for 3 h, and allowed to stand overnight. The volatiles were removed by evaporation, and the residue was dried under vacuum for 3 h. The resulting crystalline solid was dissolved in ethanol (5 mL), and ammonium acetate (1.1 g, 14.4 mmol) was added. The resulting solution was stirred at reflux for 2 h, and the solvent was evaporated. The residue was taken up in a mixture of methanol and concentrated ammonium hydroxide (20 mL, 10:1), and the solvent was then evaporated. To this residue were added water (20 mL) and concentrated ammonium hydroxide (3 mL). The resulting mixture was stirred for 1 h, cooled in an ice bath, and suction filtered to collect a solid. The solid was dried under vacuum overnight to afford the product 59 (137 mg, 29%). 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.37 (s, 9H), 1.38 (m, 2H), 1.55 (m, 2H), 2.64 (t, 2H), 2.93 (m, 2H), 6.80 (br s, 1H), 7.35 (d, 2H), 7.70 (d, 2H), 9.62 (br s, 3H).
  • 4-(4-Aminobutyl)benzamidine dihydrochloride (60)
  • 12 N hydrochloric acid (0.71 mL, 8.6 mmol) was added dropwise into a stirring solution of [4-(4-carbamimidoylphenyl)butyl]carbamic acid tert-butyl ester (59) (124 mg, 0.43 mmol) in methanol (2 mL). After stirring for 2.5 h, TLC (methylene chloride/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide, 6:3:1) indicated reaction completion. The reaction mixture was vacuum filtered. The solvent was removed from the filtrate by evaporation. Residual water was further removed as an azeotrope of toluene/methanol (1:1). Placement of the residue under vacuum for 2 h afforded the product 60 (106 mg, 94%) as a yellow foamy solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.62 (m, 4H), 2.70 (t, 2H), 2.78 (m, 2H), 3.49 (br s, 1H), 7.47 (d, 2H), 7.82 (d, 2H), 8.13 (br s, 3H), 9.25 (s, 2H), 9.42 (s, 2H).
  • 4-{4-N′-(3,5-Diamino-6-chloropyrazine-2-carbonyl)guanidino]butyl}benzamidine (61, ALB 11157)
  • 4-(4-Aminobutyl)benzamidine dihydrochloride (60) (92 mg, 0.35 mmol), triethylamine (0.24 mL, 1.74 mmol), 1-(3,5-diamino-6-chloropyrazinoyl)-2-methylisothiourea hydriodide (142 mg, 0.37 mmol) were sequentially added into ethanol (2 mL). After stirring at reflux for 2 h with argon protection, the solvent was evaporated. The residue was stirred in methylene chloride (5 mL), and suction filtered to obtain a solid. The solid was chromatographed on silica gel, eluting with methylene chloride/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide (6:3:1), to afford the pure product 61 as a yellow solid. mp 140-170° C. (decomposed). 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.96 (m, 2H), 2.09 (m, 2H), 3.43 (m, 2H), 4.08 (br s, 2H), 8.00-10.00 (m, 14H). m/z (APCI)=404 (C17H22ClN9O+H)+.
  • REFERENCES
    • 1. Rappoport, D. A.; Hassid, Z.; J. Amer. Chem. Soc., 1951, 73, 5524-5525, incorporated herein by reference, Ruth, J. A. and Claffey, D. J., Tetrahedron Lett. 1996, 37 (44), 7929-7932, incorporated herein by reference.
    Sodium Channel Blocking Activity
  • The compounds shown in the Table below were tested for potency in canine bronchial epithelia using the in vitro assay described above. Amiloride was also tested in this assay as a positive control. The results for the compounds of the present invention are reported as fold-enhancement values relative to amiloride.
  • Example 41
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00061
    R = N = Fold Amiloride*
    OH 1  50.9 ± 19.8 (3)
    OH 2  79.2 ± 30.6 (4)
    OH 4  45.3 ± 27.0 (6)
    NH 2 0  32.6 ± 2.0 (3)
    NH 2 1  26.2 ± 5.1 (3)
    NH 2 3   59 ± 5.5 (4)
    NH 2 4 132.6 ± 47.2 (5)
  • Example 42
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00062
    R = n = Fold Amiloride*
    OH 2  84.9 ± 30.3 (6)
    OH 3 105.2 ± 26.6 (7)
    OH 4   21 (1)
    NH 2 2  60.1 ± 1.3 (2)
    NH 2 2  56.5 ± 0 (4)
    NH 2 3 102.6 ± 49 (2)
  • Example 43
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00063
    X = Y = Fold Amiloride*
    C═O NH2 73.1 ± 31.5 (3)
    C═O NH(CH2)2—OH 28.5 (1)
    C═NH NH2 53.2 ± 19.3 (2)
    NH H 32.6 ± 2 (3)
    NH COCH3 52.3 ± 16.4 (3)
    NH SO2CH3 38.5 ± 4.2 (3)
    NH CO2C2H5 29.0 ± 5.8 (2)
    NH C(═NH)NH2 88.0 ± 18.0 (2)
  • Example 44
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00064
    R = R1 = Fold Amiloride*
    OR1 H 50.9 ± 19.8 (3)
    NHR1 H 28 (1)
    NHR1 COCH3 16 (1)
    NHR1 SO2CH3 50.6 ± 11.9 (2)
    NHR1 CO2C2H5 24.1 ± 0.5 (3)
    NHR1 CO2—(CH3)3 29.0 ± 4.1 (2)
    NHR C(═NH)NH2 66.2 ± 27.4 (4)
  • Example 45
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00065
    X = Fold Amiloride*
    NH2  56.5 ± 24 (4)
    NH—C(═NH)—NH2 120.6 ± 60.8 (11)
    NHSO2CH3 64.0 (1)
    NHCO2(CH3)3  51.7 ± 10.1 (2)
    NHCOCH3  48.5 ± 26.5 (4)
  • Example 46
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00066
    R = Fold Amiloride*
    —OH 14.0 ± 4.6 (7)
    —O(CH3)3 29.2 ± 10.9 (3)
    —NH2 48.2 ± 24.1 (7)
  • Example 47
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00067
    Fold Amiloride*
    CH2 CH2 ÖH  79.2 ± 30.6 (4)
    O CH2 CH2 OH  84.9 ± 30.3 (6)
    O CH2 CH2 CH2 OH 105.2 ± 26.6 (7)
    CH2 CH2 CH2 CH2 OH 37.4 (1)
    O CH2 CHOH CH2 OH 51.95 (50)
    O CH2 CHOH CH2 NH2  57.5 ± 24.5 (6)
    O CH2 CH2 CH2 CH2 OH   21 (1)
    O CH2 CH2 CHOH CH2 OH  55.5 ± 19.3 (3)
    O CH2 CHOH CHOH CH2 OH  93.7 ± 42.1 (5)
    O CH2 CHOH CHOH CH2 OH  56.1 ± 15.6 (4)
    N CH2 CHOH CHOH CH2 OH  44.9 ± 14.7 (8)
  • Example 48
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00068
    Fold Amiloride*
    NH2  32.6 ± 2 (3)
    NH R  44.9 ± 14.7 (8)
    O CH2 CH2 NH2  84.9 ± 30.3 (6)
    O CH2 CH2 NH Ra  52.9 ± 14.3 (5)
    O CH2 CH2 NR Ra,c  73.2 ± 49.3 (9)
    O CH2 CH2 O R1  76.1 (1)
    O CH2 CH2 O CH3  51.5 ± 14.9 (2)
    O R  93.7 ± 42.1 (5)
    O CH2 CHOH CH2 OH 51.95 (79)
    O CH2 CH2 NR Ra,c  56.0 (1)
    O CH2 CH2 NR2 R2,a
    aChiral
    bRacemic
    cEnantiomers
  • Example 49
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00069
  • Example 50
  • Fold Amiloride*
    O(CH2)NHCO2 + 51.7 ± 10.1 (2)
    OCH2CO2 + 29.2 ± 10.9 (3)
    OCH2CO2ET   20 (1)
    —NHCH2CO2 + 29.0 ± 4.1 (2)
    NHCO2ET 29.0 ± 5.38 (2)
    CH2NHCO2ET 24.1 ± 0.5 (3)
    O(CH2)2NHCO2ET 17.7 ± 6.0 (2)
    OCH2CHOHCH2NHCO2 + 77.9 ± 24.0 (3)
    O(CH2)3NHCO2 + 37.5 ± 12.8 (4)
    (CH2)4—NHCO2 16.9 ± 2.3 (2)
    Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00070
    R = Position Fold Amiloride*
    H Ortho 21.7 ± 4.8 (2) 
    H Meta 41.1 ± 8.5 (2) 
    H Para 80.3 ± 25.5 (9)
    CH2OH Ortho 24.0 ± 1.0 (2) 
    CH2OH Meta   40 (1)
    CH2OH Para 51.55 (79)
  • Example 51
  • Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00071
    R = \Z = H O(CH2)2—R O(CH2)3—R CH2R (CH2)3R
    OH
    Xamiloride 84.9 ± 30.3 105.2 ± 26.6 50.9 ± 19.8 (3)
    R = \Z = H O(CH2)2—R O(CH2)3—R CH2R —(CH2)3R
    NH2
    Xamiloride 32.6 + 2 56.5 ± 0 102.6 ± 49 26.2 ± 5.1 (3) 54.4 ± 43.5 (6)
    R = \Z = H O(CH2)3—R CH2R (CH2)3R
    Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00072
    Xamiloride 88.0 ± 18.0 98.0 ± 58.5 (18) 50.2 ± 17.4 (4) 35 (1) 47.6 (3)
  • Example 52 Effect of Compound 9518 on MCC
  • These experiments were conducted according to methods of Example 32 with compound 9518 and the vehicle as a control.
  • Example 53 Effect of Compound 9714 on MCC
  • These experiments were conducted according to methods of Example 32 with compound 9714 and the vehicle as a control.
  • Example 54 Effect of Compound 10833 on MCC
  • These experiments were conducted according to methods of Example 32 with compound 10833 and the vehicle as a control.
  • Obviously, numerous modifications and variations of the present invention are possible in light of the above teachings. It is therefore to be understood that within the scope of the appended claims, the invention may be practiced otherwise than as specifically described herein.

Claims (87)

1-208. (canceled)
209. A method of effecting in a subject at least one member selected from the group consisting of promoting hydration of mucosal surfaces, promoting ocular hydration, promoting corneal hydration, promoting mucus clearance in mucosal surfaces, restoring mucosal defense, preventing ventilator-induced pneumonia, treating chronic bronchitis, treating cystic fibrosis, treating sinusitis, treating vaginal dryness, treating dry eye, treating Sjogren's disease, treating distal intestinal obstruction syndrome, treating dry skin, treating esophagitis, treating dry mouth (xerostomia), treating nasal dehydration, treating chronic obstructive pulmonary disease, treating emphysema, treating pneumonia, treating constipation, treating chronic diverticulitis, treating rhinosinusitis, treating asthma, treating primary ciliary dyskinesia, and treating otitis media,
administering to a subject an effective amount of a compound represented by formula (I):
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00073
wherein
X is hydrogen, halogen, trifluoromethyl, lower alkyl, unsubstituted or substituted phenyl, lower alkyl-thio, phenyl-lower alkyl-thio, lower alkyl-sulfonyl, or phenyl-lower alkyl-sulfonyl;
Y is hydrogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, lower alkoxy, lower alkyl-thio, halogen, lower alkyl, unsubstituted or substituted mononuclear aryl, or —N(R2)2;
R1 is hydrogen or lower alkyl;
each R2 is, independently, —R7, —(CH2)m—OR8, —(CH2)m—NR7R10, —(CH2)n(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —(CH2)n—C(═O)NR7R10, —(CH2)n-Zg-R7, —(CH2)m—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2), —CO2R7, or
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00074
R3 and R4 are each, independently, hydrogen, a group represented by formula (A), lower alkyl, hydroxy lower alkyl, phenyl, phenyl-lower alkyl, (halophenyl)-lower alkyl, lower-(alkylphenylalkyl), lower (alkoxyphenyl)-lower alkyl, naphthyl-lower alkyl, or pyridyl-lower alkyl, with the proviso that at least one of R3 and R4 is a group represented by formula (A):
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00075
wherein
each RL is, independently, —R7, —(CH2)n—OR8, —O—(CH2)m—OR8, —(CH2)n—NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—NR7R10, —(CH2)n(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —(CH2)n—C(═O)NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—C(═O)NR7R10, —(CH2)n-(Z)g-R7, —O—(CH2)m-(Z)g-R7, —(CH2), —NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2)n—CO2R7, —O—(CH2)m—CO2R7—OSO3H, —O-glucuronide, —O-glucose,
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00076
each o is, independently, an integer from 0 to 10;
each p is an integer from 0 to 10;
with the proviso that the sum of o and p in each contiguous chain is from 1 to 10;
each x is, independently, O, NR10, C(═O), CHOH, C(═N—R10), CHNR7R10, or represents a single bond;
each R5 is, independently, —(CH2)m—OR8, —O—(CH2)m—OR8, —(CH2)n—NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—NR7R10, —(CH2)n(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, O—(CH2)m(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —O—(CH2CH2O),R8, —R(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —(CH2)n—C(═O)NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—C(═O)NR7R10, —(CH2)n-(Z)g-R7, —O—(CH2)m-(Z)g-R7, —(CH2)n—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2), —CO2R7, —O—(CH2)m—CO2R7, —OSO3H, —O-glucuronide, —O-glucose,
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00077
each R6 is, independently, —R7, —OR11, —N(R7)2, —(CH2)m—OR8, —O—(CH2)m—OR8, —(CH2)n—NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—NR7R10, —(CH2)n(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2CH2O)m—R8, —O—(CH2CH2O)n—R8, —(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —O—(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10, —(CH2)n—C(═O)NR7R10, —O—(CH2)m—C(═O)NR7R10, —(CH2)n-(Z)g-R7, —O—(CH2)n-(Z)g-R7, —(CH2)n—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8), —CH2OR8, —O—(CH2)m—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8, —(CH2)n—CO2R7, —O—(CH2)m—CO2R7—OSO3H, —O-glucuronide, —O-glucose,
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00078
wherein when two R6 are —OR11 and are located adjacent to each other on a phenyl ring, the alkyl moieties of the two R6 may be bonded together to form a methylenedioxy group;
each R7 is, independently, hydrogen or lower alkyl;
each R8 is, independently, hydrogen, lower alkyl, —C(═O)—R11, glucuronide, 2-tetrahydropyranyl, or
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00079
each R9 is, independently, —CO2R7, —CON(R7)2, —SO2CH3, or —C(═O)R7;
each R10 is, independently, —H, —SO2CH3, —CO2R7, —C(═O)NR7R9, —C(═O)R7, or —CH2—(CHOH)n—CH2OH;
each Z is, independently, CHOH, C(═O), CHNR7R10, C═NR10, or NR10;
each R11 is, independently, lower alkyl;
each g is, independently, an integer from 1 to 6;
each m is, independently, an integer from 1 to 7;
each n is, independently, an integer from 0 to 7;
each Q is, independently, C—R5, C—R6, or a nitrogen atom, wherein at most 3 Q in a ring is a nitrogen atom;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and
inclusive of all enantiomers, diastereomers, and racemic mixtures thereof; and a P2Y2 receptor agonist.
210. The method of claim 209, wherein the subject is human.
211. The method of claim 209, wherein promoting hydration of mucosal surfaces is effected.
212. The method of claim 209, wherein promoting ocular hydration is effected.
213. The method of claim 209, wherein promoting corneal hydration is effected.
214. The method of claim 209, wherein promoting mucus clearance in mucosal surfaces is effected.
215. The method of claim 209, wherein restoring mucosal defense is effected.
216. The method of claim 209, wherein preventing ventilator-induced pneumonia is effected.
217. The method of claim 209, wherein treating chronic bronchitis is effected.
218. The method of claim 209, wherein treating cystic fibrosis is effected.
219. The method of claim 209, wherein treating sinusitis is effected.
220. The method of claim 209, wherein treating vaginal dryness is effected.
221. The method of claim 209, wherein treating dry eye is effected.
222. The method of claim 209, wherein treating Sjogren's disease is effected.
223. The method of claim 209, wherein treating distal intestinal obstruction syndrome is effected.
224. The method of claim 209, wherein treating dry skin is effected.
225. The method of claim 209, wherein treating esophagitis is effected.
226. The method of claim 209, wherein treating dry mouth (xerostomia) is effected.
227. The method of claim 209, wherein treating nasal dehydration is effected.
228. The method of claim 209, wherein treating chronic obstructive pulmonary disease is effected.
229. The method of claim 209, wherein treating emphysema is effected.
230. The method of claim 209, wherein treating pneumonia, treating constipation is effected.
231. The method of claim 209, wherein treating chronic diverticulitis is effected.
232. The method of claim 209, wherein treating rhinosinusitis is effected.
233. The method of claim 209, wherein treating asthma is effected.
234. The method of claim 209, wherein treating primary ciliary dyskinesia is effected.
235. The method of claim 209, wherein treating otitis media is effected.
236. The method of claim 209, wherein Y is —NH2.
237. The method of claim 209, wherein R2 is hydrogen.
238. The method of claim 237, wherein R1 is hydrogen.
239. The method of claim 238, wherein X is chlorine.
240. The method of claim 239, wherein R3 is hydrogen.
241. The method of claim 240, wherein each RL is hydrogen.
242. The method of claim 241, wherein o is 4.
243. The method of claim 242, wherein p is 0.
244. The method of claim 243, wherein x represents a single bond.
245. The method of claim 244, wherein each R6 is hydrogen.
246. The method of claim 245, wherein at most one Q in a ring is a nitrogen atom.
247. The method of claim 246, wherein no Q is a nitrogen atom.
248. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —(CH2)m—OR8.
249. The method of claim 248, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00080
250. The method of claim 248, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00081
251. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —O—(CH2)n, —OR8.
252. The method of claim 251, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00082
253. The method of claim 251, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00083
254. The method of claim 251, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00084
255. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —(CH2)n—NR7R10)
256. The method of claim 255, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00085
257. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —O—(CH2)m—NR7R10.
258. The method of claim 257, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00086
259. The method of claim 257, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00087
260. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —(CH2)n(CHOR8)n(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8.
261. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —O—(CH2)m(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8.
262. The method of claim 261, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00088
263. The method of claim 261, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00089
264. The method of claim 261, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00090
265. The method of claim 261, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00091
266. The method of claim 261, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00092
267. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —(CH2CH2O)m—R8.
268. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —O—(CH2CH2O)m—R8.
269. The method of claim 268, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00093
270. The method of claim 268, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00094
271. The method of claim 268, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00095
272. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10.
273. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —O—(CH2CH2O)m—CH2CH2NR7R10.
274. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —(CH2)n—C(═O)NR7R10.
275. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —O—(CH2)m—C(═O)NR7R10.
276. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —(CH2)n-(Z)g-R7.
277. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —O—(CH2)m-(Z)g-R7.
278. The method of claim 277, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00096
279. The method of claim 277, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00097
280. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —(CH2)n—NR10)—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8.
281. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —O—(CH2)m—NR10—CH2(CHOR8)(CHOR8)n—CH2OR8.
282. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —O—(CH2)m—CO2R7.
283. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —OSO3H.
284. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —O-glucuronide.
285. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is —O-glucose.
286. The method of claim 245, wherein R5 is
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00098
287. The method of claim 286, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00099
288. The method of claim 209, wherein the compound is represented by the formula:
Figure US20090062308A1-20090305-C00100
289. The method of claim 209, wherein
X is halogen;
Y is —N(R7)2;
R1 is hydrogen or C1-C3 alkyl;
R2 is —R7, —(CH2)m—OR8, or —(CH2)n—CO2R7;
R3 is a group represented by formula (A); and
R4 is hydrogen, a group represented by formula (A), or lower alkyl.
290. The method of claim 289, wherein
X is chloro or bromo;
Y is —N(R7)2;
R2 is hydrogen or C1-C3 alkyl;
at most three R6 are other than hydrogen as defined above;
at most three RL are other than hydrogen as defined above; and
at most 2 Q in a ring are nitrogen atoms.
291. The method of claim 290, wherein Y is —NH2.
292. The method of claim 291, wherein R4 is hydrogen;
at most one RL is other than hydrogen as defined above;
at most two R6 are other than hydrogen as defined above; and
at most 1 Q in a ring is a nitrogen atom.
293. The method of claim 292, wherein no Q in a ring is a nitrogen atom.
294. The method of claim 209, wherein the P2Y2 receptor agonist is a salt.
US12/190,022 2002-02-19 2008-08-12 Methods of using sodium channel blockers Abandoned US20090062308A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US12/190,022 US20090062308A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2008-08-12 Methods of using sodium channel blockers

Applications Claiming Priority (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US10/076,571 US6858615B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2002-02-19 Phenyl guanidine sodium channel blockers
US10/828,479 US7332496B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2004-04-21 Methods of using sodium channel blockers
US11/695,936 US20070265280A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2007-04-03 Methods of using sodium channel blockers
US12/190,022 US20090062308A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2008-08-12 Methods of using sodium channel blockers

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/695,936 Continuation US20070265280A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2007-04-03 Methods of using sodium channel blockers

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20090062308A1 true US20090062308A1 (en) 2009-03-05

Family

ID=27752677

Family Applications (15)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US10/076,571 Expired - Lifetime US6858615B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2002-02-19 Phenyl guanidine sodium channel blockers
US10/532,110 Abandoned US20060142306A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2003-02-19 Sodium channel blockers
US10/828,466 Expired - Fee Related US7192960B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2004-04-21 Sodium channel blockers
US10/828,171 Expired - Fee Related US7189719B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2004-04-21 Sodium channel blockers
US10/828,352 Expired - Fee Related US7186833B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2004-04-21 Sodium channel blockers
US10/828,479 Expired - Lifetime US7332496B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2004-04-21 Methods of using sodium channel blockers
US11/695,936 Abandoned US20070265280A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2007-04-03 Methods of using sodium channel blockers
US12/179,353 Expired - Fee Related US8198286B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2008-07-24 Sodium channel blockers
US12/190,022 Abandoned US20090062308A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2008-08-12 Methods of using sodium channel blockers
US12/703,441 Expired - Fee Related US8227474B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2010-02-10 Sodium channel blockers
US13/492,711 Expired - Lifetime US8846688B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2012-06-08 Sodium channel blockers
US14/158,441 Abandoned US20140179625A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2014-01-17 Sodium channel blockers
US14/727,189 Abandoned US20150376146A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2015-06-01 Sodium channel blockers
US15/336,574 Expired - Fee Related US10167266B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2016-10-27 Sodium channel blockers
US16/181,230 Abandoned US20190241528A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2018-11-05 Sodium channel blockers

Family Applications Before (8)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US10/076,571 Expired - Lifetime US6858615B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2002-02-19 Phenyl guanidine sodium channel blockers
US10/532,110 Abandoned US20060142306A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2003-02-19 Sodium channel blockers
US10/828,466 Expired - Fee Related US7192960B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2004-04-21 Sodium channel blockers
US10/828,171 Expired - Fee Related US7189719B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2004-04-21 Sodium channel blockers
US10/828,352 Expired - Fee Related US7186833B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2004-04-21 Sodium channel blockers
US10/828,479 Expired - Lifetime US7332496B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2004-04-21 Methods of using sodium channel blockers
US11/695,936 Abandoned US20070265280A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2007-04-03 Methods of using sodium channel blockers
US12/179,353 Expired - Fee Related US8198286B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2008-07-24 Sodium channel blockers

Family Applications After (6)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/703,441 Expired - Fee Related US8227474B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2010-02-10 Sodium channel blockers
US13/492,711 Expired - Lifetime US8846688B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2012-06-08 Sodium channel blockers
US14/158,441 Abandoned US20140179625A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2014-01-17 Sodium channel blockers
US14/727,189 Abandoned US20150376146A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2015-06-01 Sodium channel blockers
US15/336,574 Expired - Fee Related US10167266B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2016-10-27 Sodium channel blockers
US16/181,230 Abandoned US20190241528A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2018-11-05 Sodium channel blockers

Country Status (14)

Country Link
US (15) US6858615B2 (en)
EP (1) EP1485360B1 (en)
JP (2) JP4557550B2 (en)
KR (3) KR101225201B1 (en)
AT (1) ATE520674T1 (en)
AU (2) AU2003211135B2 (en)
CA (1) CA2476430C (en)
CY (1) CY1112906T1 (en)
DK (1) DK1485360T3 (en)
ES (1) ES2374130T3 (en)
HK (1) HK1070369A1 (en)
PT (1) PT1485360E (en)
SI (1) SI1485360T1 (en)
WO (1) WO2003070182A2 (en)

Cited By (18)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20090104272A1 (en) * 2007-10-10 2009-04-23 Parion Sciences, Inc. Inhaled hypertonic saline delivered by a heated nasal cannula
US20090214444A1 (en) * 2008-02-26 2009-08-27 Parion Sciences, Inc. Poly aromatic sodium channel blockers
US20100074881A1 (en) * 2008-07-11 2010-03-25 Parion Sciences, Inc. Multiple nebulizer systems
US20110003832A1 (en) * 2005-08-03 2011-01-06 Parion Sciences, Inc. NEW CAPPED Pyrazinoylguanidine SODIUM CHANNEL BLOCKERS
US20110046158A1 (en) * 2003-08-18 2011-02-24 Parion Sciences, Inc. Capped pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US8669262B2 (en) 2011-06-27 2014-03-11 Parion Sciences, Inc. 3,5-diamino-6-chloro-N-(N-(4-(4-(2-(hexyl(2,3,4,5,6-pentahydroxyhexyl)amino)ethoxy)phenyl)butyl)carbamimidoyl)pyrazine-2-carboxamide
US8778383B2 (en) 2011-06-07 2014-07-15 Parion Sciences, Inc. Methods of treatment
US8846688B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2014-09-30 Parion Sciences, Inc. Sodium channel blockers
US8945605B2 (en) 2011-06-07 2015-02-03 Parion Sciences, Inc. Aerosol delivery systems, compositions and methods
US8980898B2 (en) 2012-05-29 2015-03-17 Parion Sciences, Inc. Dendrimer like amino amides possessing sodium channel blocker activity for the treatment of dry eye and other mucosal diseases
US9029382B2 (en) 2012-12-17 2015-05-12 Parion Sciences, Inc. 3,5-diamino-6-chloro-N-(N-(4-phenylbutyl)carbamimidoyl) pyrazine-2-carboxamide compounds
US9072738B2 (en) 2011-06-27 2015-07-07 Parion Sciences, Inc. Chemically and metabolically stable dipeptide possessing potent sodium channel blocker activity
US9102633B2 (en) 2013-12-13 2015-08-11 Parion Sciences, Inc. Arylalkyl- and aryloxyalkyl-substituted epithelial sodium channel blocking compounds
US9346753B2 (en) 2013-08-23 2016-05-24 Parion Sciences, Inc. Dithiol mucolytic agents
US9593084B2 (en) 2012-12-17 2017-03-14 Parion Sciences, Inc. Chloro-pyrazine carboxamide derivatives with epithelial sodium channel blocking activity
US9856224B2 (en) 2014-06-30 2018-01-02 Parion Sciences, Inc. Stable sodium channel blockers
US10106551B2 (en) 2015-01-30 2018-10-23 Parion Sciences, Inc. Monothiol mucolytic agents
US10526283B2 (en) 2015-04-30 2020-01-07 Parion Sciences, Inc. Prodrugs of dithiol mucolytic agents

Families Citing this family (37)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US6858614B2 (en) * 2002-02-19 2005-02-22 Parion Sciences, Inc. Phenolic guanidine sodium channel blockers
US6903105B2 (en) 2003-02-19 2005-06-07 Parion Sciences, Inc. Sodium channel blockers
US20050090505A1 (en) * 2003-08-18 2005-04-28 Johnson Michael R. Methods of reducing risk of infection from pathogens
KR20060037450A (en) * 2003-08-18 2006-05-03 패리온 사이언스 인코퍼레이티드 Cyclic pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
EP1670475A4 (en) * 2003-08-18 2009-04-15 Parion Sciences Inc Alaphatic pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US7745442B2 (en) * 2003-08-20 2010-06-29 Parion Sciences, Inc. Methods of reducing risk of infection from pathogens
EP1685845A4 (en) * 2003-11-19 2009-02-11 Meiji Seika Kaisha Sialogogue and, containing the same, oral composition and food composition
GB0403864D0 (en) * 2004-02-20 2004-03-24 Ucl Ventures Modulator
US8143256B2 (en) 2004-08-18 2012-03-27 Parion Sciences, Inc. Cyclic amide and ester pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
JP2008510702A (en) * 2004-08-18 2008-04-10 マイケル・アール・ジョンソン Aliphatic amide and ester pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US7399766B2 (en) * 2004-08-18 2008-07-15 Parion Sciences, Inc. Soluble amide & ester pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US20070021439A1 (en) * 2005-07-25 2007-01-25 Parion Sciences, Inc. Methods of reducing risk of infection from pathogens with soluble amide and ester pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
AU2012201188B2 (en) * 2005-08-03 2013-02-07 Parion Sciences, Inc. New capped pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
GB0526244D0 (en) 2005-12-22 2006-02-01 Novartis Ag Organic compounds
CA2653773A1 (en) * 2006-06-09 2007-12-21 Parion Sciences, Inc. Cyclic substituted pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers possessing beta agonist activity
SI2035004T1 (en) * 2006-06-09 2012-12-31 Parion Sciences, Inc. Phenyl substituted pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers possessing beta agonist activity
WO2007146867A2 (en) * 2006-06-09 2007-12-21 Parion Sciences Inc. Aliphatic pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers with beta agonist activity
JP2010502738A (en) * 2006-09-07 2010-01-28 パリオン・サイエンシィズ・インコーポレーテッド Methods for enhancing mucosal hydration and mucosal clearance by treatment with sodium channel blockers and osmotic regulators
JP2010502739A (en) * 2006-09-07 2010-01-28 パリオン・サイエンシィズ・インコーポレーテッド Improvement of mucosal hydration and mucus clearance by treatment with sodium channel inhibitors and osmotic regulators
EP1939173A1 (en) * 2006-12-21 2008-07-02 Pharmeste S.r.l. O-substituted-dibenzyl urea- or thiourea- derivatives as trpv1 receptor antagonists
WO2008124496A1 (en) * 2007-04-03 2008-10-16 Parion Sciences, Inc. Method of treating acid-sensing ion channel mediated pain, cough, and central nervous system disorders
US8288391B2 (en) * 2007-04-03 2012-10-16 Parion Sciences, Inc. Pyrazinoylguanidine compounds for use as taste modulators
PE20091096A1 (en) * 2007-12-10 2009-08-25 Novartis Ag ORGANIC COMPOUNDS
WO2011081937A1 (en) 2009-12-15 2011-07-07 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Corticosteroid-beta-agonist-muscarinic antagonist compounds for use in therapy
US8394829B2 (en) 2010-05-10 2013-03-12 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Bi-functional quinoline analogs
WO2011143106A1 (en) 2010-05-10 2011-11-17 Gilead Sciences, Inc. Bi - functional pyrazolopyridine compounds
WO2011156355A1 (en) * 2010-06-09 2011-12-15 Kainos Medicine, Inc. Production method of phenyl guanidine salts and their intermediates
EP2646107A2 (en) 2010-12-01 2013-10-09 Spinal Modulation Inc. Agent delivery systems for selective neuromodulation
CA2896686A1 (en) 2012-12-17 2014-06-26 Parion Sciences, Inc. 3,5-diamino-6-chloro-n-(n-(4-phenylbutyl)carbamimidoyl) pyrazine-2- carboxamide compounds
JP6461134B2 (en) * 2013-07-15 2019-01-30 ベーリンガー インゲルハイム インターナショナル ゲゼルシャフト ミット ベシュレンクテル ハフツング New benzimidazolium compounds
EP3022197B1 (en) * 2013-07-15 2017-09-06 Boehringer Ingelheim International GmbH Novel tetra- and pentasubstituted benzimidazolium compounds
UY36034A (en) 2014-03-18 2015-09-30 Astrazeneca Ab DERIVATIVES OF 3,5-DIAMINO-6-CHLORINE-PIRAZINA-2-CARBOXAMIDE AND PHARMACEUTICALLY ACCEPTABLE SALTS OF THESE
WO2016133967A2 (en) * 2015-02-18 2016-08-25 Parion Sciences, Inc. Sodium channel blockers for skin disorders
GB201610854D0 (en) 2016-06-21 2016-08-03 Entpr Therapeutics Ltd Compounds
GB201619694D0 (en) 2016-11-22 2017-01-04 Entpr Therapeutics Ltd Compounds
GB201717051D0 (en) 2017-10-17 2017-11-29 Enterprise Therapeutics Ltd Compounds
GB201808093D0 (en) 2018-05-18 2018-07-04 Enterprise Therapeutics Ltd Compounds

Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20090227530A1 (en) * 2002-02-19 2009-09-10 Parion Sciences, Inc. Sodium channel blockers

Family Cites Families (349)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US3268406A (en) 1961-10-12 1966-08-23 Merck & Co Inc Compositions and method of using (3-amino-pyrazinoyl) guanidines
NL6409716A (en) 1962-10-30 1965-10-01
US3316266A (en) 1964-03-31 1967-04-25 Merck & Co Inc 3-aminopyrazinoic acid derivatives and process for their preparation
NL299929A (en) 1962-10-30
NL299931A (en) 1962-10-30
DK109779C (en) 1962-10-30 1968-07-01 Merck & Co Inc Process for the preparation of 3-aminopyrazinamidoguanidine compounds or acid addition salts thereof.
NL6409714A (en) 1962-10-30 1965-10-01
US3274191A (en) 1963-11-15 1966-09-20 Merck & Co Inc N-(3-aminopyrazinoyl) benzamidines and process for preparing
US3240780A (en) 1963-12-23 1966-03-15 Merck & Co Inc Amino-pyrazinoyl guanidines
DE1245967B (en) 1964-03-31 1967-08-03 Merck &. Co., Inc., Rahway, N.J. (V. St. A.) Process for the preparation of S.S-diamino-o-chloro-pyrazinecarboxylic acid alkyl esters
NL6501301A (en) 1964-04-03 1965-10-04
US3249610A (en) 1964-09-08 1966-05-03 Merck & Co Inc Synthesis of 3-amino, 5-chloro, 6-substituted-pyrazinoates
DE1281818B (en) 1965-07-17 1968-10-31 Rheinische Kalksteinwerke Process for the simultaneous grinding of several raw materials with different grindability
US3274192A (en) 1965-10-04 1966-09-20 Merck & Co Inc Derivatives of pyrazine and a method for their preparation
US3341540A (en) 1965-10-04 1967-09-12 Merck & Co Inc 3-amino-6-halopyrazinonitriles and their syntheses
US3305552A (en) 1965-11-22 1967-02-21 Merck & Co Inc 3-aminopyrazinoic acids and process for their preparation
US3361748A (en) 1965-11-22 1968-01-02 Merck & Co Inc Process for the preparation of pteridinones
NL6707564A (en) 1966-08-25 1968-02-26
FR1525671A (en) 1966-08-25 1968-05-17 Merck & Co Inc Process for preparing (3, 5 - diamino - 6 - halo - pyrazinoyl) - guanidines and (3, 5 - diamino - 6 - halo -pyrazinamido) guanidines
FR1525670A (en) 1966-08-25 1968-05-17 Merck & Co Inc Process for manufacturing substituted guanidines
IL27897A (en) 1966-08-25 1972-02-29 Merck & Co Inc Preparation of pyrazinoylguanidines and pyrazinamidoguanidines
US3472848A (en) 1966-11-17 1969-10-14 Merck & Co Inc 3-hydroxy and 3-mercapto-pyrazinoyl-guanidines,corresponding ethers and thioethers and processes for their preparation
US3660400A (en) 1966-11-17 1972-05-02 Merck & Co Inc Lower alkyl 3-hydroxy and 3-mercaptopyrazinoates
US3527758A (en) 1967-04-13 1970-09-08 Merck & Co Inc Process for the preparation of pyrazinoylguanidines from a pyrazinoic azide and a guanidine
US3507865A (en) 1967-04-27 1970-04-21 Merck & Co Inc 3-hydroxy- and 3-mercaptopyrazinamidoguanidines the corresponding ethers and thioethers and processes for their preparation
US3507866A (en) 1967-08-08 1970-04-21 Merck & Co Inc 1h - imidazo(4,5-b)pyrazin - 2 - one and processes for their preparation
US3487082A (en) 1967-09-28 1969-12-30 Merck & Co Inc 2,4 - diamino - 6 - halopteridines and processes for their preparation
US3503973A (en) 1967-11-07 1970-03-31 Merck & Co Inc Process for preparation of pyrazinoylguanidines
US3515723A (en) 1967-11-14 1970-06-02 Merck & Co Inc 2 - (5 - amino - 1h - 1,2,4 - triazol - 3 - yl)- 3-aminopyrazines and processes for their preparation
US3531484A (en) 1968-02-14 1970-09-29 Merck & Co Inc 1-(3-aminopyrazinoyl)-4,5,5-trisubstituted biguanide products
US3461123A (en) 1968-04-12 1969-08-12 Merck & Co Inc 1h-imidazo(4,5-b)pyrazin-2-ones and processes for their preparation
US3506662A (en) 1968-04-30 1970-04-14 Merck & Co Inc Process for preparation of pyrazinoyland pyrazinamidoguanidines
US3625950A (en) 1968-07-03 1971-12-07 Merck & Co Inc Certain halophenoxy alkanamides, hydrazides and derivatives thereof
US3575975A (en) 1968-07-25 1971-04-20 Merck & Co Inc Process for the preparation of 3-aminopyrazinoylureas
US3539569A (en) * 1968-08-21 1970-11-10 Merck & Co Inc Preparation of pyrazinoylguanidines from pyrazinoylureas
US3544571A (en) 1968-09-04 1970-12-01 Merck & Co Inc Process for making pyrazinoylthiourea compounds
US3555024A (en) 1968-11-13 1971-01-12 Merck & Co Inc 1-(3-aminopyrazinoyl)semicarbazides,1-(3-aminopyrazinoyl) - thiosemicarbazides,and method for their preparation
US3555023A (en) 1968-11-13 1971-01-12 Merck & Co Inc 1-(3 - aminopyrazinoyl) - 3 - substituted-3-thioisosemicarbazides and method for preparation
US3668241A (en) 1968-11-25 1972-06-06 Merck & Co Inc Substituted 1-oxoinden-5-yloxy alkanoic acids
US3586688A (en) 1968-12-18 1971-06-22 Merck & Co Inc Certain aminopyridinecarbonyl guanidines
US3573305A (en) 1968-12-30 1971-03-30 Merck & Co Inc (3-amino-pyrazinoyl)sulfamides and their preparation
US3577418A (en) 1969-02-12 1971-05-04 Merck & Co Inc Pyrazinamide derivatives and processes for their preparation
US3573306A (en) * 1969-03-05 1971-03-30 Merck & Co Inc Process for preparation of n-substituted 3,5-diamino-6-halopyrazinamides
US3544568A (en) 1969-03-18 1970-12-01 Merck & Co Inc 3-amino-5,6-substituted pyrazinamides
US3660397A (en) 1970-04-17 1972-05-02 Merck & Co Inc Imidazo(4 5-b)pyrazines
US3864401A (en) 1970-12-23 1975-02-04 Merck & Co Inc Substituted 2-aminomethyl-4,6-dihalophenols
US3794734A (en) 1971-03-03 1974-02-26 Merck & Co Inc Methods of treating edema and hypertension using certain 2-aminoethylphenols
US3935313A (en) 1971-03-29 1976-01-27 Jan Marcel Didier Aron-Samuel Pharmaceutical composition containing N-(3-diethyl-aminopropyl)-4-nitro-1-oxide-pyridine-2-carboxamide and process for the treatment of hypertension therewith
US3948895A (en) 1971-09-28 1976-04-06 E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company Synthesis of 3,5-diaminopyrazinoic acid from 3,5-diamino-2,6-dicyanopyrazine and intermediates
BE791201A (en) 1971-11-12 1973-05-10 Merck & Co Inc INDANYLOXYTETRAZOLES
US3953476A (en) 1971-12-27 1976-04-27 Merck & Co., Inc. 3-Amino-5-sulfonylbenzoic acids
US3894085A (en) 1972-09-19 1975-07-08 Ciba Geigy Corp New 2-halo nitrones, their manufacture and their use for the manufacture of N-substituted araliphatic aldehyde-nitrones
US4081554A (en) 1972-10-13 1978-03-28 Merck & Co., Inc. 1-oxo-2,2-disubstituted-5-indanyloxy(or thio)alkano acids
US3984465A (en) 1972-10-13 1976-10-05 Merck & Co., Inc. 1-Oxo-2,2-disubstituted-5-indanyloxy(or thio)alkanoic acids
US4085219A (en) 1972-10-13 1978-04-18 Merck & Co., Inc. 1-Oxo-2,2-disubstituted-5-indanyloxy(or thio)alkanoic acids
US3976686A (en) 1972-10-13 1976-08-24 Merck & Co., Inc. [1-Oxo-2,3-hydrocarbylene-5-indanyloxy(or thio)]alkanoic acids
US4091015A (en) 1972-10-27 1978-05-23 American Home Products Corporation 15-Substituted prostanoic acids
US4092356A (en) 1972-10-30 1978-05-30 Merck & Co., Inc. 11,12-Secoprostaglandins
US4066692A (en) 1972-10-30 1978-01-03 Merck & Co., Inc. 11,12-secoprostaglandins
US4055597A (en) 1973-01-26 1977-10-25 Merck & Co., Inc. 10-Aza-11,12-secoprostaglandins
US3987091A (en) 1973-04-12 1976-10-19 Merck & Co., Inc. 11,12-secoprostaglandins
US4091107A (en) 1973-04-25 1978-05-23 Merck & Co., Inc. 8-Aza-9-oxo(and dioxo)-thia-11,12-secoprostaglandins
US4033996A (en) 1973-04-25 1977-07-05 Merck & Co., Inc. 8-Aza-9-oxo(and dioxo)-thia-11,12-secoprostaglandins
US3894065A (en) 1973-04-27 1975-07-08 Merck & Co Inc Aryl-oxo-alkanoic acids
US4182764A (en) 1973-10-11 1980-01-08 Merck & Co., Inc. Tetrazole derivatives of [1-oxo-2-aryl or thienyl-2-substituted-5-indanyloxy(or thio)]alkanoic acids
US4177285A (en) 1973-10-11 1979-12-04 Merck & Co., Inc. [1-Oxo-2-thienyl-2-substituted-5-indanyloxy (or thio)]alkanoic acids and derivatives thereof
US4006180A (en) 1973-10-12 1977-02-01 Merck & Co., Inc. [1,3-Dihydroxy-2-substituted and 2,2-disubstituted-indanyloxy(or thio)]alkanoic acids
US4003927A (en) 1973-10-12 1977-01-18 Merck & Co., Inc. (1-Oxo-7,8-disubstituted-1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-6-naphthyloxy)- and (3,4-disubstituted-5-oxo-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-5H-benzocycloheptene-2-yloxy) acetic acids and derivatives
US3976681A (en) 1973-10-12 1976-08-24 Merck & Co., Inc. [1,3-Dioxo-2-substituted and 2,2-disubstituted- indanyloxy (or thio] alkanoic acids
US3966966A (en) 1973-10-12 1976-06-29 Merck & Co., Inc. Pharmaceutical compositions and method of treatment employing 1,3-dioxo-2,2-disubstituted indanyloxy alkanoic acids
US3929872A (en) 1973-10-12 1975-12-30 Merck & Co Inc Indanacetic acid compounds
US4012524A (en) 1973-10-12 1977-03-15 Merck & Co., Inc. [1-Hydroxy-5-indanyloxy (or thio)]-alkanoic acids
US3989749A (en) 1973-10-17 1976-11-02 Merck & Co., Inc. 11,12-Secoprostaglandins
US3991087A (en) 1973-12-13 1976-11-09 Merck & Co., Inc. 8-Halo-11,12-secoprostaglandins
US3979361A (en) 1974-02-20 1976-09-07 Merck & Co., Inc. 2-Aminomethyl-6-trihalo-methylphenols
US3914253A (en) 1974-03-04 1975-10-21 Merck & Co Inc 5-Oxo-6-substituted-cyclopent-{8 f{9 -indole-2-carboxylic acids
US3931239A (en) 1974-04-03 1976-01-06 Merck & Co., Inc. 6-Oxo-7-substituted-6H-indeno-[5,4-b]furan(and thiophene)-carboxylic acids
US3958004A (en) 1974-04-23 1976-05-18 Merck & Co., Inc. Phenoxyacetic acid derivatives as uricosuric agents
US3928624A (en) 1974-04-25 1975-12-23 Merck & Co Inc Phenol compounds in treating pain, fever and inflammation
US3956374A (en) 1974-05-03 1976-05-11 Merck & Co., Inc. Aryl-oxo-heptenoic acids
US3974212A (en) 1974-05-22 1976-08-10 Merck & Co., Inc. [1-Hydroximino-2,2-disubstituted-5-indanyloxy-(or thio)]alkanoic acids
AT351182B (en) 1974-06-25 1979-07-10 Merck & Co Inc METHOD FOR THE PRODUCTION OF NEW 9-THIA, 9-OXOTHIA AND 9-DIOXOTHIA-11,12-SECOPROSTA-GLANDINES
PL98342B1 (en) 1974-07-30 1978-04-29 METHOD FOR THE PRODUCTION OF 1-KETO-2-ARYL- / OR THENYL / -2-SUBSTITUTED-INDANOXY- / OR THIO / -5-ALCOXYLIC ACID
US4020177A (en) 1974-08-30 1977-04-26 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted phenoxy-tridecanoic acids
US3991106A (en) 1974-09-13 1976-11-09 Merck & Co., Inc. 16-Ethers of 8-aza-9-dioxothia-11,12-seco-prostaglandins
US4055596A (en) 1974-09-13 1977-10-25 Merck & Co., Inc. 11,12-Seco-prostaglandins
US3984552A (en) 1975-02-24 1976-10-05 Merck & Co., Inc. 6-Oxo-7-substituted and 7,7-disubstituted-6H-indeno-[5,4-b]furan (and thiophene) carboxylic acids
JPS51116341A (en) 1975-04-04 1976-10-13 Automob Antipollut & Saf Res Center Detection apparatus for oil pressure
US4018802A (en) 1975-04-09 1977-04-19 Merck & Co., Inc. 9-Thia- and oxothia- and 9-dioxothia-11,12-seco-prostaglandins and processes
US4097504A (en) 1975-04-23 1978-06-27 Merck & Co., Inc. 11,12-Secoprostaglandins
US4092414A (en) 1975-04-25 1978-05-30 Merck & Co., Inc. 3,4-Dihydrospiro-2H-1,3-benzoxazines and their use in treating edema, abnormal electrolyte retention, and inflammation
US4059601A (en) 1975-06-06 1977-11-22 Merck & Co., Inc. 8-Halo-11,12-secoprostaglandins
US4059602A (en) 1975-06-06 1977-11-22 Merck & Co., Inc. 8-Methyl-, phenyl-, or substituted phenyl-11,12-secoprostaglandins
US4061643A (en) 1975-06-18 1977-12-06 Merck & Co., Inc. Certain 16-aryloxy-11,12-seco-prostaglandins
US4087542A (en) 1975-07-09 1978-05-02 Merck & Co., Inc. 2,3-Dihydro-6,7-disubstituted-5-acyl benzofuran-2-carboxylic acids
US4181727A (en) 1975-07-09 1980-01-01 Merck & Co., Inc. 2,3-Dihydro-6,7-disubstituted-5-acyl benzofuran-2-carboxylic acids
US4296122A (en) 1975-07-09 1981-10-20 Merck & Co., Inc. 2,3-Dihydro-6,7-disubstituted-5-(acyl)benzofuran-2-carboxylic acids
US4044153A (en) 1975-08-01 1977-08-23 Merck & Co., Inc. Antiinflammatory 2-aminomethyl-6-trihalomethylphenols
US4203988A (en) 1975-11-12 1980-05-20 Merck & Co., Inc. Pyridinyl ureas and pharmaceutical use
US4029816A (en) 1975-11-25 1977-06-14 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted 2-aminomethyl-6-iodophenols
US4085211A (en) 1975-12-15 1978-04-18 Merck & Co., Inc. Pyrazinecarboxamides and processes for preparing same
US4070464A (en) 1976-02-19 1978-01-24 Merck & Co., Inc. Method of treating autoimmune diseases
US4085125A (en) 1976-03-22 1978-04-18 Merck & Co., Inc. 9-Thia-, 9-oxothia-, and 9-dioxothia-11,12-seco-prostaglandins and processes
US4128564A (en) 1976-03-22 1978-12-05 Merck & Co., Inc. 9-Thia- and oxothia- and 9-dioxothia-11,12-seco-prostaglandins
US4181661A (en) 1976-05-03 1980-01-01 Merck & Co., Inc. Derivatives of 2-iminothiazolidines and thiazolines
US4029803A (en) 1976-05-03 1977-06-14 Merck & Co., Inc. Method of treatment with 2-iminothiazolidines and thiazolines
US4059587A (en) 1976-05-24 1977-11-22 Merck & Co., Inc. Certain thiazolidine compounds
US4022794A (en) 1976-05-24 1977-05-10 Merck & Co., Inc. Novel analogs of prostaglandins with 4-oxo-thiazolidinyl nucleus and method of preparation thereof
US4054652A (en) 1976-06-15 1977-10-18 Merck & Co., Inc. Dihydro- and tetrahydro- iminothiazines
NL7705652A (en) 1976-06-15 1977-12-19 Merck & Co Inc 2-IMINO-3-AMINOTHIAZOLIDINS.
US4025625A (en) 1976-06-15 1977-05-24 Merck & Co., Inc. Imidazothiazines
US4087526A (en) 1976-07-23 1978-05-02 Merck & Co., Inc. (3-Amino-5-substituted-6-fluoropyrazinoyl or pyrazamido)-guanidines and their derivatives bearing substituents on the guanidino nitrogens
US4111877A (en) 1976-07-29 1978-09-05 Air Products & Chemicals, Inc. Allyl esters of n-alkyl-omega-(alkyleneureido) amic acids and their synthesis and use in aqueous emulsion polymer systems
US4067980A (en) 1976-08-16 1978-01-10 Merck & Co., Inc. Spirobenzoxazinium salts, method of use and compositions thereof as antihypertensive agents
US4085117A (en) 1976-10-18 1978-04-18 Merck & Co., Inc. 6,7-Disubstituted-5-(acyl)benzofuran-2-carboxylic acids
US4100294A (en) 1976-12-06 1978-07-11 Merck & Co., Inc. 5-(Hydroxy (substituted) methyl)-2,3-dihydrobenzo furan-2-carboxylic acid and its derivatives
US4175203A (en) 1976-12-17 1979-11-20 Merck & Co., Inc. Interphenylene 11,12-secoprostaglandins
US4150235A (en) 1976-12-17 1979-04-17 Merck & Co., Inc. Interphenylene 11,12-secoprostaglandins
US4105769A (en) 1977-01-24 1978-08-08 Merck & Co., Inc. Inhibition of indoleamine-N-methyl transferase by 2-iminopyridines
US4087435A (en) 1977-02-17 1978-05-02 Merck & Co., Inc. 8-Aza-9-dioxothiaprostanoic acids
US4115573A (en) 1977-03-04 1978-09-19 Merck & Co., Inc. N-pyrazinecarbonyl-N'-substituted-sulfamoylguanidine and processes for preparing same
US4208413A (en) 1977-03-04 1980-06-17 Merck & Co., Inc. N-Pyrazinecarbonyl-N'-alkoxycarbonyl and N',N"-bis(alkoxycarbonyl)guanidines and processes for preparing same
US4112236A (en) 1977-04-04 1978-09-05 Merck & Co., Inc. Interphenylene 8-aza-9-dioxothia-11,12-secoprostaglandins
US4108859A (en) 1977-06-06 1978-08-22 The Dow Chemical Company Microbicidal (pyridinylamino) alkyl guanidines
US4115402A (en) 1977-06-17 1978-09-19 Merck & Co., Inc. 2,3-Dichloro-4-[(substituted-sulfonyl)-phenoxy]-acetic acids
US4196292A (en) 1977-06-29 1980-04-01 Merck & Co., Inc. 6-Substituted amiloride derivatives
US4229456A (en) 1977-07-18 1980-10-21 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted naphthyridinones and processes for their preparations
US4133885A (en) 1977-07-18 1979-01-09 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted naphthyridinones
US4536507A (en) 1977-07-26 1985-08-20 Merck & Co., Inc. Prostaglandin antagonists
US4093728A (en) 1977-08-18 1978-06-06 E. R. Squibb & Sons, Inc. Triazoloisoindoles
US4140776A (en) 1977-09-16 1979-02-20 Merck & Co., Inc. N-pyrazinecarbonyl-N'-acylguanidines
US4130566A (en) 1977-10-27 1978-12-19 Sumitomo Chemical Company, Limited Process for producing 5-carboxy-2-acetylthiophene
US4127584A (en) 1977-11-11 1978-11-28 Merck & Co., Inc. 2,3-Substituted-1,2,5-thiadiazolium salt antimicrobials
US4159279A (en) 1977-11-23 1979-06-26 Merck & Co., Inc. Nuclear substituted 2-hydroxyphenylmethanesulfamic acids
US4267341A (en) 1977-11-23 1981-05-12 Merck & Co., Inc. Process for preparing 2,3-substituted-1,2,-isothiazolium salt antimicrobials
US4292430A (en) 1977-11-23 1981-09-29 Merck & Co., Inc. 2,3-Substituted-1,2-isothiazolium salt antimicrobials
US4166177A (en) 1977-12-27 1979-08-28 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted 2,2-dioxo-1,2,3-benzoxathiazines
US4145551A (en) 1978-01-09 1979-03-20 Merck & Co., Inc. Pyrazine-2-carbonyloxyguanidines
US4401669A (en) 1978-01-27 1983-08-30 Merck & Co., Inc. 2,3-Dihydro-substituted-5-benzoyl benzofuran-2-carboxylic acids and their use in treating hypertension
US4189496A (en) 1978-02-16 1980-02-19 Merck & Co., Inc. 2,3-Dihydro-5-thienylmethyl and furylmethyl-6-substituted and 6,7-disubstituted-benzofuran-2-carboxylic acid
US4163781A (en) 1978-04-17 1979-08-07 Merck & Co., Inc. 3-Amino-N-[(phosphonoamino)iminomethyl]-6-halopyrazinecarboxamide compounds, compositions and methods of use
US4156005A (en) 1978-06-21 1979-05-22 Merck & Co., Inc. Derivatives of 1,2-benzisoxazoles
US4394515A (en) 1978-06-23 1983-07-19 Merck & Co., Inc. 10,11-Dihydro-11-oxodibenzo[b,f]thiepin compounds
US4263207A (en) 1978-08-01 1981-04-21 Merck & Co., Inc. 10,11-Dihydrodibenzo[b,f][1,4]thiazepine carboxylic acids esters and amides thereof
US4190655A (en) 1978-08-28 1980-02-26 Merck & Co., Inc. Amiloride citrate
US4226867A (en) 1978-10-06 1980-10-07 Merck & Co., Inc. 3,3-Substituted spiro-1,2,4-benzothiadiazines
US4187315A (en) 1978-10-11 1980-02-05 Merck & Co., Inc. N-alkyl(and cycloalkyl)oxamic acid and derivatives as inhibitors of glycolic acid oxidase
US4178386A (en) 1978-10-11 1979-12-11 Merck & Co., Inc. Inhibitors of glycolic acid oxidase
US4207329A (en) 1978-10-11 1980-06-10 Merck & Co., Inc. Derivatives of glycolic and glyoxylic acid as inhibitors of glycolic acid oxidase
US4390537A (en) 1978-11-16 1983-06-28 Merck & Co., Inc. 1-(Substituted-aminoalkoxyphenyl)-2-methylene-1-alkanones, compositions and use
US4342782A (en) 1978-11-16 1982-08-03 Merck & Co., Inc. 1-(Substituted-aminoalkoxyphenyl)-2-methylene-1-alkanones, compositions and use thereof
US4282365A (en) 1978-11-24 1981-08-04 Merck & Co., Inc. Dibenz[b,e]oxepin compounds
US4249021A (en) 1979-02-26 1981-02-03 Merck & Co., Inc. Indanacetic acid compounds
US4224447A (en) 1979-03-27 1980-09-23 Merck & Co., Inc. Novel pyrazinecarboxamides and processes for preparing same
US4246406A (en) 1979-03-27 1981-01-20 Merck & Co., Inc. Heterocyclic substituted pyrazinoylguanidines
US4221790A (en) 1979-04-16 1980-09-09 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted 2,2-dioxo-1,2,3-benzoxathiazines
US4233452A (en) 1979-05-03 1980-11-11 Merck & Co., Inc. Derivatives of glycolic and glyoxylic acid as inhibitors of glycolic acid oxidase
US4220654A (en) 1979-06-04 1980-09-02 Merck & Co., Inc. Cyclic imidazole cyanoguanidines
US4537902A (en) 1979-06-11 1985-08-27 Merck & Co., Inc. 4-Substituted-3-hydroxy-3-pyrroline-2,5-dione inhibitors of glycolic acid oxidase
US4256758A (en) 1979-06-11 1981-03-17 Merck & Co., Inc. 4-Substituted-3-hydroxy-3-pyrroline-2,5-dione inhibitors of glycolic acid oxidase
US4431660A (en) 1979-06-11 1984-02-14 Merck & Co., Inc. (4'-Biphenylyloxy and-thio-oxy)-3-hydroxy-3-pyrroline-2,5-diones and a method of treating calcium oxalate renal lithiasis therewith
US4237144A (en) 1979-06-21 1980-12-02 Merck & Co., Inc. 2,3-Dihydro-2,6,7-trisubstituted-5-acylbenzofurans
US4237130A (en) 1979-06-21 1980-12-02 Merck & Co., Inc. 2,3-Dihydro-6,7-disubstituted-5-(substituted sulfonyl)benzofuran-2-carboxylic acids
US4291050A (en) 1979-06-21 1981-09-22 Merck & Co., Inc. 6,7-Disubstituted-2 or 2,2-substituted-5-substituted-1-indanones
JPS6034925B2 (en) 1979-07-31 1985-08-12 帝人株式会社 Long-acting nasal preparation and its manufacturing method
US4375475A (en) 1979-08-17 1983-03-01 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted pyranone inhibitors of cholesterol synthesis
US4710513A (en) 1979-08-17 1987-12-01 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted pyranone inhibitors of cholesterol synthesis
US4567289A (en) 1979-08-17 1986-01-28 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted pyranone inhibitors of cholesterol synthesis
US4459422A (en) 1979-08-17 1984-07-10 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted pyranone inhibitors of cholesterol synthesis
US4296237A (en) 1979-09-11 1981-10-20 Merck & Co., Inc. 4-(Pyridyl, piperazinyl and thiazolyl substituted thiazolyl)-3-hydroxy-3-pyrroline-2,5-diones
US4298743A (en) 1979-09-11 1981-11-03 Merck & Co., Inc. 4-(Substituted phenyl thiazolyl)-3-hydroxy-3-pyrroline-2,5-diones
US4377588A (en) 1979-09-11 1983-03-22 Merck Sharp & Dohme (I.A.) Corp. 4-(Substituted thiazolyl)-3-hydroxy-3-pyrroline-2,5-dione inhibitors of glycolic acid oxidase
US4379791A (en) 1979-09-11 1983-04-12 Merck & Co., Inc. 4-(Substituted thiazolyl)-3-hydroxy-3-pyrroline-2,5-dione inhibitors of glycolic acid oxidase
US4356313A (en) 1979-10-19 1982-10-26 Merck & Co., Inc. [(5,6,9a-substituted-3-oxo-1,2,9,9a-tetrahydro-3H-fluoren-7-yl)oxy]alkanoic and cycloalkanoic acid esters and their analogs, the parent acids and their salts
US4317922A (en) 1979-10-19 1982-03-02 Merck & Co., Inc. [(5,6,9a-Substituted-3-oxo-1,2,9,9a-tetrahydro-3H-fluoren-7-yl)oxy]alkanoic and cycloalkanoic acids and their analogs, esters, salts and derivatives
US4337354A (en) 1979-10-19 1982-06-29 Merck & Co., Inc. [(5,6,9a-Substituted-3-oxo-1,2,9,9a-tetrahydro-3H-fluoren-7-yl)oxy]alkanoic and cycloalkanoic acids, their analogs, esters, salts, and derivatives
US4448786A (en) 1979-11-05 1984-05-15 Merck & Co., Inc. 4-Naphthyl and substituted naphthyl-3-hydroxy-3-pyrroline-2,5-diones and their use as inhibitors of glycolic acid oxidase
US4342776A (en) 1979-11-05 1982-08-03 Merck & Co., Inc. 4-Substituted-3-hydroxy-3-pyrroline-2,5-dione inhibitors of glycolic acid oxidase
US4349561A (en) 1979-11-05 1982-09-14 Merck & Co., Inc. 4-Substituted-3-hydroxy-3-pyrroline-2,5-dione inhibitors of glycolic acid oxidase
US4432992A (en) 1979-11-05 1984-02-21 Merck & Co., Inc. 4-[5(and 4)-Substituted-2-thienyl]-3-hydroxy-3-pyrroline-2,5-dione inhibitors of glycolic acid oxidase
US4464363A (en) 1979-12-20 1984-08-07 Merck & Co., Inc. Ajuvants for rectal delivery of drug substances
US4260771A (en) 1979-12-20 1981-04-07 Merck & Co., Inc. Interphenylene 9-thia-11-oxo-12-azaprostanoic acid compounds
US4428959A (en) 1980-04-04 1984-01-31 Merck & Co., Inc. 4-Alkylsubstituted-3-hydroxy-3-pyrroline-2,5-dione inhibitors of glycolic acid oxidase
US4309540A (en) 1980-05-19 1982-01-05 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted pyrazinyl-1,2,4-oxadiazoles
US4362724A (en) 1980-05-19 1982-12-07 Merck & Co., Inc. Method of treating edema and hypertension and pharmaceutical composition therefor in which the active ingredient comprises a novel substituted pyrazinyl-1,2,4-oxadiazole and a kaliuretic diuretic
US4356314A (en) 1980-06-30 1982-10-26 Merck & Co., Inc. [5,6,9A-Substituted-3-oxo-1,2,9,9a-tetrahydro-3H-fluoren-7-yl)oxy]alkanoic and cycloalkanoic acids, their analogs, esters, salts, and derivatives
US4277602A (en) 1980-07-02 1981-07-07 Merck & Co., Inc. 3-Amino-5-substituted-6-halo-N-(3,4-dihydro-6-substituted-1,3,5-truazin-2-yl)2-pyrazinecarboxamides
US4317822A (en) 1980-07-02 1982-03-02 Merck & Co., Inc. 3-Amino-5-substituted-6-halo-N-(3,4-dihydro-6-substituted-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)2-pyrazinecarboxamides
US4272537A (en) 1980-07-02 1981-06-09 Merck & Co., Inc. 3-Amino-5-substituted-6-halo-N-(4,4-disubstituted-6-substituted-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)-2-pyrazinecarboxamides
US4465850A (en) 1980-09-02 1984-08-14 Merck & Co., Inc. Treatment of brain injury due to gray matter edema with (indanyloxy) butanoic acids
US4389417A (en) 1980-09-05 1983-06-21 Merck & Co., Inc. Treatment of gray matter edema
US4394385A (en) 1980-11-21 1983-07-19 Merck & Co., Inc. Treatment of gray matter edema
US4316043A (en) 1980-12-19 1982-02-16 Merck & Co., Inc. [(5,6,9a-Substituted-3-oxo-1,2,9,9a-tetrahydro-3H-fluoren-7-yl)oxy]alkanoic and cycloalkanoic acids and their analogs, esters, salts and derivatives
US4428956A (en) 1980-12-29 1984-01-31 Merck & Co., Inc. 4-Hydroxy-5-substituted-3-(2H)-isothiazolone-1,1-dioxide derivatives useful in treating urinary tract calcium oxalate lithiasis
US4336397A (en) 1980-12-29 1982-06-22 Merck & Co., Inc. 2,4-Dioxo-4-substituted-1-butanoic acid derivatives useful in treating urinary tract calcium oxalate lithiasis
US4431652A (en) 1980-12-29 1984-02-14 Merck & Co., Inc. 4-Hydroxy-5-substituted-3(2H)-isothiazolone-1,1-dioxide derivatives useful in treating urinary tract calcium oxalate lithiasis
US4337258A (en) 1980-12-29 1982-06-29 Merck & Co., Inc. 2,4-Dioxo-4-substituted-1-butanoic acid derivatives useful in treating urinary tract calcium oxalate lithiasis
US4778897A (en) 1981-02-25 1988-10-18 Merck & Co., Inc. 6H-dibenz[b,e][1,4]oxathiepin compounds
US4582842A (en) 1981-02-25 1986-04-15 Merck & Co., Inc. Anti-asthmatic 6H-dibenz-[b,e] [1,4]oxathiepin derivatives, compositions, and method of use therefor
US4454132A (en) 1981-03-16 1984-06-12 Merck & Co., Inc. Pharmaceutical compositions of novel substituted pyrazinyl-1,2,4-oxadiazoles useful in the treatment of edema and hypertension
US4510322A (en) 1981-07-13 1985-04-09 Merck & Co., Inc. Indacrinone having enhanced uricosuric
US4420615A (en) 1981-08-24 1983-12-13 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted pyridopyrimidines as gastric secretion inhibitors
US4425337A (en) 1981-12-30 1984-01-10 Merck & Co., Inc. Adjuvants for rectal delivery of drug
US4463208A (en) 1981-12-30 1984-07-31 Merck & Co., Inc. Treatment of gray matter edema
US4952582A (en) 1982-01-04 1990-08-28 Beyer Jr Karl H Pyrazinoylguanidine and derivatives thereof having few polar substituents and being useful as hyperuretic agents
US4594349A (en) 1982-01-04 1986-06-10 Beyer Jr Karl H Hyperuretic agents
US4663322A (en) 1982-01-04 1987-05-05 Beyer Jr Karl H Antihypertensive hyperuretic and saluretic agent combinations
US4389393A (en) 1982-03-26 1983-06-21 Forest Laboratories, Inc. Sustained release therapeutic compositions based on high molecular weight hydroxypropylmethylcellulose
US4440740A (en) 1982-04-26 1984-04-03 Merck & Co., Inc. α-Keto aldehydes as enhancing agents of gastro-intestinal drug absorption
US4501729A (en) 1982-12-13 1985-02-26 Research Corporation Aerosolized amiloride treatment of retained pulmonary secretions
JPS6032714A (en) 1983-08-01 1985-02-19 Teijin Ltd Stabilized powdery pharmaceutical composition for application to nasal mucous membrane
US4699917A (en) 1983-09-26 1987-10-13 Merck & Co., Inc. Anti-asthmatic tetrazolyl 6H-dibenz-[B,E]-[1,4]-oxathiepin derivatives, compositions, and method of use therefor
US4634717A (en) 1984-05-01 1987-01-06 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted-3-(2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-5-yl)-4-hydroxy-1H-pyrrole-2,5-diones, useful for treating persons with gray matter edema
US4680414A (en) 1984-05-01 1987-07-14 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted-3-(2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-5-yl)-4-hydroxy-1H-pyrrole-2,5-diones
US4605663A (en) 1984-05-01 1986-08-12 Merck & Co., Inc. Use of substituted-3-(2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-5-yl)-4-hydroxy-1H-pyrrole-2,5-diones, for treatment of grey matter edema
US4604403A (en) 1984-05-01 1986-08-05 Merck & Co., Inc. Use of substituted-3(2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-5-yl)-4-hydroxy-1H-pyrrole-2,5-diones for treating grey matter edema
US4605664A (en) 1984-05-01 1986-08-12 Merck & Co., Inc. Use of substituted-3-(2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-5-yl)-4-hydroxy-1H-pyrrole-2,5-diones for treatment of grey matter edema
US4596821A (en) 1984-05-01 1986-06-24 Merck & Co., Inc. Treatment of gray matter edema with 3-(2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-5-yl)-4-hydroxy-1H-pyrrole-2,5-diones
US4604394A (en) 1984-10-01 1986-08-05 Merck & Co., Inc. Antiarrhythmic compositions and method
US4754061A (en) 1985-06-04 1988-06-28 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted (2,3-dihydro-1-oxo-1H-inden-5-yl)alkanoic acids, their derivatives and their salts
US4579869A (en) 1985-08-02 1986-04-01 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted [(2,3-dihydro-1-oxo-1H-inden-5-yl)amino]alkanoic acids, their derivatives and their salts
US4654365A (en) 1985-09-26 1987-03-31 Merck & Co., Inc. 2,3-dihydro-5-(3-oxo-2-cyclohexen-1-yl)-2-benzofurancarboxylic acids, and their salts useful in the treatment of brain injury
US4604396A (en) 1985-09-26 1986-08-05 Merck & Co., Inc. [(2,3,9,9a-tetrahydro-3-oxo-9a-substituted-1H-fluoren-7-yl)oxy]ethanimidamides and [(2,3,9,9a-tetrahydro-3-oxo-9a-substituted-1H-fluoren-7-yl)oxy]ethanimidic acid hydrazides, their derivatives and their salts
US4719310A (en) 1985-12-23 1988-01-12 Merck & Co., Inc. Ester and amide substituted (2,3-dihydro-4-(3-oxo-1-cyclohexen-1-yl)phenoxy)alkanoic acids and their salts
US4625047A (en) 1985-12-23 1986-11-25 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted (2,3-dihydro-4-(3-oxo-1-cyclohexen-1-yl)phenoxy) alkanoic acids, their derivatives and their salts
US4835313A (en) 1986-03-03 1989-05-30 Merck & Co., Inc. (5,6-dichloro-3-oxo-9α-propyl-2,3,9,9α-tetrahydrofluoren-7-yl) alkanimidamides
US4731472A (en) 1986-03-03 1988-03-15 Merck & Co., Inc. (5,6-dichloro-3-oxo-9A-propyl-2,3,9,9A-tetrahydrofluoren-7-yl)alkanoic acids and alkanimidamides
US4777281A (en) 1986-03-03 1988-10-11 Merck & Co., Inc. [3,4-dichloro-6,7,8,8a,9,10-hexahydro-6-oxo-8a-substituted-2-phenanthrenyl)oxy]-alkanoic acids and -ethanimidamides
US4731473A (en) 1986-04-04 1988-03-15 Merck & Co., Inc. Compounds useful in treating sickle cell anemia
US4751244A (en) 1986-04-04 1988-06-14 Merck & Co., Inc. Compounds useful in treating sickle cell anemia
US4699926A (en) 1986-04-04 1987-10-13 Merck & Co., Inc. Compounds useful in treating sickle cell anemia
US4731381A (en) 1986-04-04 1988-03-15 Merck & Co., Inc. Method of treating a person for sickle cell anemia
US4675341A (en) 1986-08-13 1987-06-23 Merck & Co., Inc. [(5,6-dichloro-3-oxo-9a-propyl-2,3,9,9a-tetrahydrofluoren-7-yl)oxy]ethanol and its derivatives
US4937232A (en) 1986-09-15 1990-06-26 Duke University Inhibition of protein kinase C by long-chain bases
US4797391A (en) 1986-09-24 1989-01-10 Merck & Co., Inc. ((5,6-dichloro-3-oxo-9,9a-disubstituted-2,3,9,9a-tetrahydrofluoren-7-yl)oxy)alkanoic acids and alkanimidamides
US4769370A (en) 1986-09-24 1988-09-06 Merck & Co., Inc. (1,2-dichloro-8-oxo-5a-substituted-5a,6,7,8-tetrahydrodibenzofuran-3-yl)alkanoic acids and alkanimidamides
US4731470A (en) 1986-11-03 1988-03-15 Merck & Co., Inc. [(5,6-dichloro-3-oxo-2,9a-alkano-2,3,9,9a-tetrahydro-1H-fluoren-7-yl)oxy]alkanoic acids and alkanimidamides
US4731471A (en) 1986-11-03 1988-03-15 Merck & Co., Inc. (5,6-dichloro-3-oxo-2,3,9,9a-tetrahydrofluoren-7-yl)-alkanoic acids and alkanimidamides bearing novel functional 9a-substituents
US4782073A (en) 1986-12-24 1988-11-01 Merck & Co., Inc. Amides of [(5,6-dichloro-3-oxo-9-alpha-substituted-2,3,9,9-alpha-tetrahydrofluoren-7-yl-oxyl]acetic acids, and pharmaceutical compositions thereof
US4775695A (en) 1987-06-01 1988-10-04 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted amidinoalkoxy and amidinoalkylamino indanones and salts thereof
US4771076A (en) 1987-06-01 1988-09-13 Merck & Co., Inc. [(2-substituted 1,2-dihydro-1-oxo-1H-inden-5-yl)oxy]alkanesulfonic acids and salts thereof
US5132296A (en) 1987-08-14 1992-07-21 Cherksey Bruce D Membrane NA+ channel protein and related therapeutic compounds
US5242947A (en) 1988-02-10 1993-09-07 New York University Use of polyamines as ionic-channel regulating agents
US4894376A (en) * 1988-02-26 1990-01-16 Trustees Of The University Of Pennsylvania Methods of treating diseases characterized by hyperexcitability of neurons
US4923874A (en) 1988-07-21 1990-05-08 G. D. Searle & Co. Use of 8-azapurin-6-one derivatives for control of hypertension
US5707644A (en) 1989-11-04 1998-01-13 Danbiosyst Uk Limited Small particle compositions for intranasal drug delivery
US5215991A (en) 1990-01-26 1993-06-01 Allergan, Inc. Combination of selective alpha-adrenergic agonists and Na+ /H+ ex
US5449682A (en) 1990-02-13 1995-09-12 Merck & Co., Inc. Angiotensin II antagonists incorporating a substituted benzyl element
US5182299A (en) 1990-03-19 1993-01-26 Brigham And Women's Hospital Treatment of osmotic disturbance with organic osmolytes
AU654979B2 (en) 1990-10-05 1994-12-01 University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill, The Method of administering amiloride
EP0517573A1 (en) 1991-06-05 1992-12-09 Synthelabo Pharmaceutical compositions for the treatment of airway disorders
US5292498A (en) 1991-06-19 1994-03-08 The University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill Method of treating lung disease with uridine triphosphates
US5312820A (en) 1992-07-17 1994-05-17 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted carbamoyl and oxycarbonyl derivatives of biphenylmethylamines
DE4236237A1 (en) 1992-10-27 1994-04-28 Behringwerke Ag Prodrugs, their preparation and use as medicines
DE59403818D1 (en) 1993-02-20 1997-10-02 Hoechst Ag Substituted benzoylguanidines, processes for their preparation, their use as medicaments, as inhibitors of cellular Na + / H + exchange or as diagnostic agents and medicaments containing them
US5384128A (en) 1993-03-02 1995-01-24 University Of Alabama Research Foundation Method of and compounds for treatment for cystic fibrosis
US5512269A (en) 1993-06-09 1996-04-30 Burroughs Wellcome, Co. Method of treating retained pulmonary secretions
US6051576A (en) 1994-01-28 2000-04-18 University Of Kentucky Research Foundation Means to achieve sustained release of synergistic drugs by conjugation
AUPM411494A0 (en) 1994-02-25 1994-03-24 Central Sydney Area Health Service Method and device for the provocation of upper or lower airway narrowing and/or the induction of sputum
US6190691B1 (en) 1994-04-12 2001-02-20 Adolor Corporation Methods for treating inflammatory conditions
US5962477A (en) 1994-04-12 1999-10-05 Adolor Corporation Screening methods for cytokine inhibitors
US5538991A (en) 1994-09-14 1996-07-23 Merck & Co., Inc. Endothelin antagonists bearing 5-membered heterocyclic amides
US5618557A (en) 1994-11-22 1997-04-08 E.R. Squibb & Sons, Inc. Prophylactic treatment of allergic contact dermatitis
US5656256A (en) 1994-12-14 1997-08-12 The University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill Methods of treating lung disease by an aerosol containing benzamil or phenamil
US5908611A (en) 1995-05-05 1999-06-01 The Scripps Research Institute Treatment of viscous mucous-associated diseases
US5635160A (en) 1995-06-07 1997-06-03 The University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill Dinucleotides useful for the treatment of cystic fibrosis and for hydrating mucus secretions
US5994336A (en) 1995-06-07 1999-11-30 Magainin Pharmaceuticals Inc. Method of inhibiting proliferation of cells by administering an aminosterol compound
US5628984A (en) 1995-07-31 1997-05-13 University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill Method of detecting lung disease
US5855918A (en) 1995-09-12 1999-01-05 Genentech, Inc. Cystic fibrosis therapy
US6399585B1 (en) 1996-05-15 2002-06-04 Janet E. Larson In Utero treatment of CFTR-related deficiencies
US6015828A (en) 1996-05-31 2000-01-18 Cuppoletti; John Chemical modification of chloride channels as a treatment for cystic fibrosis and other diseases
US6071910A (en) 1996-12-05 2000-06-06 Mayo Foundation For Medical Education And Research Use of agents to treat eosinophil-associated pathologies
ZA987847B (en) 1997-08-29 1999-06-28 Univ North Carolina Method of treating lung diseases with uridine 5'-diphosphate and analogs thereof
US6153187A (en) 1997-09-02 2000-11-28 Insight Strategy & Marketing Ltd. Use of glycosaminoglycans degrading enzymes for management of airway associated diseases
US6159968A (en) 1998-01-15 2000-12-12 University Of Cincinnati Activation of chloride channels for correction of defective chloride transport
US6291514B1 (en) 1998-02-09 2001-09-18 3-Dimensional Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Heteroaryl amidines, methylamidines and guanidines, preparation thereof, and use thereof as protease inhibitors
ATE232733T1 (en) 1998-05-22 2003-03-15 Inspire Pharmaceuticals Inc THERAPEUTIC DINUCLEOTIDES AND DERIVATIVES THEREOF
US6294188B1 (en) 1998-07-09 2001-09-25 Aviana Biopharm Inc. Methods involving changing the constitutive and stimulated secretions of the local reproductive system of women
NZ509489A (en) 1998-08-04 2002-10-25 Jago Res A Medicinal aerosol formulations comprising cromoglycic acid and/or nedocromil
US6458338B1 (en) 1998-09-22 2002-10-01 Aeropharm Technology Incorporated Amino acid stabilized medicinal aerosol formulations
US6136294C1 (en) 1998-09-22 2002-09-24 Aeropharm Technology Inc Amino acid stabilized medical aerosol formulation
WO2000023023A1 (en) 1998-10-20 2000-04-27 The University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill Methods of hydrating mucosal surfaces
EP1126832A2 (en) 1998-10-27 2001-08-29 Yale University Conductance of improperly folded proteins through the secretory pathway
US6926911B1 (en) 1998-12-22 2005-08-09 The University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill Compounds and methods for the treatment of airway diseases and for the delivery of airway drugs
AU3612600A (en) 1999-02-26 2000-09-14 Inspire Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Method of promoting mucosal hydration with certain uridine, adenine and cytidine diphosphates and analogs thereof
US20040195160A1 (en) 1999-07-12 2004-10-07 Marine Desalination Systems, L.L.C. Hydrate-based reduction of fluid inventories and concentration of aqueous and other water-containing products
US6475509B1 (en) 1999-07-19 2002-11-05 The University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill Covalent conjugates of sodium channel blockers and active compounds
US6297226B1 (en) 1999-10-15 2001-10-02 Neotherapeutics, Inc. Synthesis and methods of use of 9-substituted guanine derivatives
AUPQ344799A0 (en) 1999-10-15 1999-11-11 University Of Sydney, The Treatment of respiratory diseases and infections
JO2178B1 (en) 1999-10-19 2003-04-23 اف . هوفمان لاروش ايه جي Treatment of emphysema using rar selective retinoid antagonists
US6204270B1 (en) 1999-11-12 2001-03-20 Eyal S. Ron Ophthalmic and mucosal preparations
US6476048B1 (en) 1999-12-07 2002-11-05 Inotek Pharamaceuticals Corporation Substituted phenanthridinones and methods of use thereof
WO2001055390A1 (en) 2000-01-28 2001-08-02 Human Genome Sciences, Inc. Human serpin polynucleotides, polypeptides, and antibodies
US20040199456A1 (en) 2000-08-01 2004-10-07 Andrew Flint Method and apparatus for explaining credit scores
WO2002040457A1 (en) 2000-11-20 2002-05-23 Biovitrum Ab Piperazinylpyrazines compounds as antagonists of serotonin 5-ht2 receptor
DE10101440B4 (en) 2001-01-15 2017-10-26 REMS-WERK Christian Föll und Söhne GmbH & Co. Compression pliers
US20030135716A1 (en) 2002-01-14 2003-07-17 Gil Vinitzky Method of creating a high performance virtual multiprocessor by adding a new dimension to a processor's pipeline
US6858614B2 (en) * 2002-02-19 2005-02-22 Parion Sciences, Inc. Phenolic guanidine sodium channel blockers
US20050227974A9 (en) 2002-08-01 2005-10-13 Euro-Celtique S.A. Aminoalkyl-substituted aryl compounds and their use as sodium channel blockers
US6777721B1 (en) * 2002-11-14 2004-08-17 Altera Corporation SCR device for ESD protection
US6903105B2 (en) * 2003-02-19 2005-06-07 Parion Sciences, Inc. Sodium channel blockers
US7064129B2 (en) * 2003-08-18 2006-06-20 Parion Sciences, Inc. Capped pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
EP1670475A4 (en) * 2003-08-18 2009-04-15 Parion Sciences Inc Alaphatic pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US20050090505A1 (en) * 2003-08-18 2005-04-28 Johnson Michael R. Methods of reducing risk of infection from pathogens
KR20060037450A (en) 2003-08-18 2006-05-03 패리온 사이언스 인코퍼레이티드 Cyclic pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US7745442B2 (en) * 2003-08-20 2010-06-29 Parion Sciences, Inc. Methods of reducing risk of infection from pathogens
US20090253714A1 (en) 2003-08-20 2009-10-08 Johnson Michael R Methods of reducing risk of infection from pathogens
US7030717B2 (en) * 2004-05-19 2006-04-18 Soontai Tech Co., Ltd Impedance-matching wave filter
US7375102B2 (en) 2004-06-28 2008-05-20 Amgen Sf, Llc Tetrahydroquinazolin-4(3H)-one-related and tetrahydropyrido[2,3-D]pyrimidin-4(3H)-one-related compounds, compositions and methods for their use
US20090324724A1 (en) 2004-08-18 2009-12-31 Parion Sciences, Inc. Soluble amide & ester pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
JP2008510702A (en) 2004-08-18 2008-04-10 マイケル・アール・ジョンソン Aliphatic amide and ester pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US7399766B2 (en) 2004-08-18 2008-07-15 Parion Sciences, Inc. Soluble amide & ester pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US8143256B2 (en) 2004-08-18 2012-03-27 Parion Sciences, Inc. Cyclic amide and ester pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
JP4964469B2 (en) 2005-01-14 2012-06-27 ガジック・テクニカル・エンタープライゼス Vacuum chuck and spinstand for testing magnetic heads and disks
US20070021439A1 (en) 2005-07-25 2007-01-25 Parion Sciences, Inc. Methods of reducing risk of infection from pathogens with soluble amide and ester pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US7807834B2 (en) 2005-08-03 2010-10-05 Parion Sciences, Inc. Capped pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
GB0526240D0 (en) 2005-12-22 2006-02-01 Novartis Ag Organic compounds
GB0526244D0 (en) 2005-12-22 2006-02-01 Novartis Ag Organic compounds
ES2377840T3 (en) 2006-05-12 2012-04-02 Vertex Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Compositions of N- [2,4-bis (1,1-dimethylethyl) -5-hydroxyphenyl] -1,4-dihydro-4-oxoquinoline-3-carboxamide
CA2653773A1 (en) 2006-06-09 2007-12-21 Parion Sciences, Inc. Cyclic substituted pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers possessing beta agonist activity
WO2007146867A2 (en) 2006-06-09 2007-12-21 Parion Sciences Inc. Aliphatic pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers with beta agonist activity
SI2035004T1 (en) 2006-06-09 2012-12-31 Parion Sciences, Inc. Phenyl substituted pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers possessing beta agonist activity
JP2010502738A (en) 2006-09-07 2010-01-28 パリオン・サイエンシィズ・インコーポレーテッド Methods for enhancing mucosal hydration and mucosal clearance by treatment with sodium channel blockers and osmotic regulators
JP2010502739A (en) 2006-09-07 2010-01-28 パリオン・サイエンシィズ・インコーポレーテッド Improvement of mucosal hydration and mucus clearance by treatment with sodium channel inhibitors and osmotic regulators
CN101534813A (en) 2006-09-07 2009-09-16 帕里昂科学公司 Methods of enhancing mucosal hydration and mucosal clearance by treatment with sodium channel blockers and osmolytes
WO2008124496A1 (en) 2007-04-03 2008-10-16 Parion Sciences, Inc. Method of treating acid-sensing ion channel mediated pain, cough, and central nervous system disorders
US8288391B2 (en) 2007-04-03 2012-10-16 Parion Sciences, Inc. Pyrazinoylguanidine compounds for use as taste modulators
EA200901489A1 (en) 2007-05-07 2010-04-30 Новартис Аг ORGANIC COMPOUNDS
AU2008310734B2 (en) 2007-10-10 2014-06-05 Parion Sciences, Inc. Delivering osmolytes by nasal cannula
PE20091096A1 (en) 2007-12-10 2009-08-25 Novartis Ag ORGANIC COMPOUNDS
US8124607B2 (en) 2008-02-26 2012-02-28 Parion Sciences, Inc. Poly aromatic pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US8261047B2 (en) 2008-03-17 2012-09-04 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Qualification of conditional debug instructions based on address
US8664228B2 (en) 2008-05-13 2014-03-04 Novartis Ag 3,5-diamino-6-chloro-pyrazine-2-carboxylic acid derivatives and their use as epithelial sodium channel blockers for the treatment of airway diseases
MX2010013675A (en) 2008-06-10 2011-02-15 Novartis Ag Pyrazine derivatives as epithelial sodium channel blockers.
US20100074881A1 (en) 2008-07-11 2010-03-25 Parion Sciences, Inc. Multiple nebulizer systems
AU2009308241B2 (en) 2008-10-23 2016-01-07 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Solid forms of N-(4-(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl) phenyl)-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxamide
US8247436B2 (en) 2010-03-19 2012-08-21 Novartis Ag Pyridine and pyrazine derivative for the treatment of CF
WO2011156355A1 (en) 2010-06-09 2011-12-15 Kainos Medicine, Inc. Production method of phenyl guanidine salts and their intermediates
KR20120017648A (en) 2010-08-19 2012-02-29 삼성전자주식회사 Display apparatus and driving method of display panel
AR086745A1 (en) 2011-06-27 2014-01-22 Parion Sciences Inc 3,5-DIAMINO-6-CHLORINE-N- (N- (4- (4- (2- (HEXIL (2,3,4,5,6-PENTAHYDROXIHEXIL)) AMINO) ETOXI) PHENYL) BUTIL) CARBAMIMIDOIL) PIRAZINA -2-CARBOXAMIDE
HUE032851T2 (en) 2011-06-27 2017-11-28 Parion Sciences Inc A chemically and metabolically stable dipeptide possessing potent sodium channel blocker activity
HUE039734T2 (en) 2012-05-29 2019-01-28 Parion Sciences Inc Dendrimer like amino amides possessing sodium channel blocker activity for the treatment of dry eye and other mucosal diseases
US20150307530A1 (en) 2012-08-31 2015-10-29 Parion Sciences, Inc. Novel mucolytic agents
HUE032868T2 (en) 2012-11-15 2017-11-28 Bayer Pharma AG 5-fluoro-n-(pyridin-2-yl)pyridin-2-amine derivatives containing a sulfoximine group
RU2018138195A (en) 2012-12-17 2018-12-18 Пэрион Сайенсиз, Инк. COMPOUNDS 3,5-DIAMINO-6-CHLORO-N- (N- (4-Phenylbutyl) Carbamimidoyl) Pyrazine-2-Carboxamide
ES2619954T3 (en) 2012-12-17 2017-06-27 Parion Sciences, Inc. Chloropiracinocarboxamide derivatives useful for the treatment of diseases favored by insufficient mucous hydration
CA2922162A1 (en) 2013-08-23 2015-02-26 Parion Sciences, Inc. Dithiol mucolytic agents
US9102633B2 (en) 2013-12-13 2015-08-11 Parion Sciences, Inc. Arylalkyl- and aryloxyalkyl-substituted epithelial sodium channel blocking compounds
US20150376145A1 (en) 2014-06-30 2015-12-31 Parion Sciences, Inc. Stable sodium channel blockers

Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20090227530A1 (en) * 2002-02-19 2009-09-10 Parion Sciences, Inc. Sodium channel blockers

Cited By (43)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US10167266B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2019-01-01 Parion Sciences, Inc. Sodium channel blockers
US8846688B2 (en) 2002-02-19 2014-09-30 Parion Sciences, Inc. Sodium channel blockers
US8431579B2 (en) 2003-08-18 2013-04-30 Parion Sciences, Inc. Capped pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US20110046158A1 (en) * 2003-08-18 2011-02-24 Parion Sciences, Inc. Capped pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US20110003832A1 (en) * 2005-08-03 2011-01-06 Parion Sciences, Inc. NEW CAPPED Pyrazinoylguanidine SODIUM CHANNEL BLOCKERS
US8507497B2 (en) 2005-08-03 2013-08-13 Parion Sciences, Inc. Capped pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US8211895B2 (en) 2005-08-03 2012-07-03 Parion Sciences, Inc. Capped pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US9408988B2 (en) 2007-10-10 2016-08-09 Parion Sciences, Inc. Inhaled hypertonic saline delivered by a heated nasal cannula
US8551534B2 (en) 2007-10-10 2013-10-08 Parion Sciences, Inc. Inhaled hypertonic saline delivered by a heated nasal cannula
US9987443B2 (en) 2007-10-10 2018-06-05 Parion Sciences, Inc. Inhaled hypertonic saline delivered by a heated nasal cannula
US20090104272A1 (en) * 2007-10-10 2009-04-23 Parion Sciences, Inc. Inhaled hypertonic saline delivered by a heated nasal cannula
US8124607B2 (en) 2008-02-26 2012-02-28 Parion Sciences, Inc. Poly aromatic pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US8575176B2 (en) 2008-02-26 2013-11-05 Parion Sciences, Inc. Heteroaromatic pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US20090214444A1 (en) * 2008-02-26 2009-08-27 Parion Sciences, Inc. Poly aromatic sodium channel blockers
US20100074881A1 (en) * 2008-07-11 2010-03-25 Parion Sciences, Inc. Multiple nebulizer systems
US10335558B2 (en) 2011-06-07 2019-07-02 Parion Sciences, Inc. Methods of treatment
US8778383B2 (en) 2011-06-07 2014-07-15 Parion Sciences, Inc. Methods of treatment
US8945605B2 (en) 2011-06-07 2015-02-03 Parion Sciences, Inc. Aerosol delivery systems, compositions and methods
US11578042B2 (en) 2011-06-27 2023-02-14 Parion Sciences, Inc. 3,5-diamino-6-chloro-N-(N-(4-(4-(2-(hexyl(2,3,4,5,6-pentahydroxyhexyl)amino)ethoxy)phenyl)butyl)carbamimidoyl)pyrazine-2-carboxamide
US9072738B2 (en) 2011-06-27 2015-07-07 Parion Sciences, Inc. Chemically and metabolically stable dipeptide possessing potent sodium channel blocker activity
US10752597B2 (en) 2011-06-27 2020-08-25 Parion Sciences, Inc. 3,5-diamino-6-chloro-N—(N-(4-(4-(2-(hexyl(2,3,4,5,6-pentahydroxyhexyl)amino)ethoxy)phenyl)butyl)carbamimidoyl)pyrazine-2-carboxamide
US9586910B2 (en) 2011-06-27 2017-03-07 Parion Sciences, Inc. 3,5-diamino-6-chloro-N-(N-(4-(4-(2-(hexyl(2,3,4,5,6-pentahydroxyhexyl)amino)ethoxy)phenyl)butyl)carbamimidoyl)pyrazine-2-carboxamide
US9655896B2 (en) 2011-06-27 2017-05-23 Parion Sciences, Inc. Chemically and metabolically stable dipeptide possessing potent sodium channel blocker activity
US8669262B2 (en) 2011-06-27 2014-03-11 Parion Sciences, Inc. 3,5-diamino-6-chloro-N-(N-(4-(4-(2-(hexyl(2,3,4,5,6-pentahydroxyhexyl)amino)ethoxy)phenyl)butyl)carbamimidoyl)pyrazine-2-carboxamide
US9260398B2 (en) 2012-05-29 2016-02-16 Parion Sciences, Inc. Dendrimer like amino amides possessing sodium channel blocker activity for the treatment of dry eye and other mucosal diseases
US9878988B2 (en) 2012-05-29 2018-01-30 Parion Sciences, Inc. Dendrimer like amino amides possessing sodium channel blocker activity for the treatment of dry eye and other mucosal diseases
US8980898B2 (en) 2012-05-29 2015-03-17 Parion Sciences, Inc. Dendrimer like amino amides possessing sodium channel blocker activity for the treatment of dry eye and other mucosal diseases
US10526292B2 (en) 2012-05-29 2020-01-07 Parion Sciences, Inc. Dendrimer like amino amides possessing sodium channel blocker activity for the treatment of dry eye and other mucosal diseases
US9029382B2 (en) 2012-12-17 2015-05-12 Parion Sciences, Inc. 3,5-diamino-6-chloro-N-(N-(4-phenylbutyl)carbamimidoyl) pyrazine-2-carboxamide compounds
US9695134B2 (en) 2012-12-17 2017-07-04 Parion Sciences, Inc. 3,5-diamino-6-chloro-N-(n-(4-phenylbutyl)carbamimidoyl)pyrazine-2-carboxamide compounds
US10246425B2 (en) 2012-12-17 2019-04-02 Parion Sciences, Inc. 3,5-diamino-6-chloro-N-(N-(4-phenylbutyl)carbamimidoyl) pyrazine-2-carboxamide compounds
US9593084B2 (en) 2012-12-17 2017-03-14 Parion Sciences, Inc. Chloro-pyrazine carboxamide derivatives with epithelial sodium channel blocking activity
US10071970B2 (en) 2012-12-17 2018-09-11 Parion Sciences, Inc. Chloro-pyrazine carboxamide derivatives with epithelial sodium channel blocking activity
US9346753B2 (en) 2013-08-23 2016-05-24 Parion Sciences, Inc. Dithiol mucolytic agents
US9963427B2 (en) 2013-08-23 2018-05-08 Parion Sciences, Inc. Dithiol mucolytic agents
US10233158B2 (en) 2013-12-13 2019-03-19 Parion Sciences, Inc. Arylalkyl- and aryloxyalkyl-substituted epithelial sodium channel blocking compounds
US9957238B2 (en) 2013-12-13 2018-05-01 Parion Sciences, Inc. Arylalkyl-and aryloxyalkyl-substituted epithelial sodium channel blocking compounds
US9586911B2 (en) 2013-12-13 2017-03-07 Parion Sciences, Inc. Arylalkyl- and aryloxyalkyl-substituted epthelial sodium channel blocking compounds
US9102633B2 (en) 2013-12-13 2015-08-11 Parion Sciences, Inc. Arylalkyl- and aryloxyalkyl-substituted epithelial sodium channel blocking compounds
US9856224B2 (en) 2014-06-30 2018-01-02 Parion Sciences, Inc. Stable sodium channel blockers
US10106551B2 (en) 2015-01-30 2018-10-23 Parion Sciences, Inc. Monothiol mucolytic agents
US10968233B2 (en) 2015-01-30 2021-04-06 Parion Sciences, Inc. Monothiol mucolytic agents
US10526283B2 (en) 2015-04-30 2020-01-07 Parion Sciences, Inc. Prodrugs of dithiol mucolytic agents

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
WO2003070182A3 (en) 2003-12-24
PT1485360E (en) 2011-11-28
ES2374130T3 (en) 2012-02-14
US8227474B2 (en) 2012-07-24
JP4557550B2 (en) 2010-10-06
US7186833B2 (en) 2007-03-06
US8198286B2 (en) 2012-06-12
EP1485360A2 (en) 2004-12-15
US20100144661A1 (en) 2010-06-10
AU2003211135B2 (en) 2009-07-23
JP2005530692A (en) 2005-10-13
KR20100134802A (en) 2010-12-23
US20040198749A1 (en) 2004-10-07
CA2476430A1 (en) 2003-08-28
CA2476430C (en) 2011-11-08
US20060142306A1 (en) 2006-06-29
US6858615B2 (en) 2005-02-22
US20040204425A1 (en) 2004-10-14
DK1485360T3 (en) 2011-12-05
WO2003070182A2 (en) 2003-08-28
US7192960B2 (en) 2007-03-20
SI1485360T1 (en) 2012-02-29
KR20100134801A (en) 2010-12-23
US7332496B2 (en) 2008-02-19
AU2003211135A1 (en) 2003-09-09
US20140179625A1 (en) 2014-06-26
US7189719B2 (en) 2007-03-13
US20070265280A1 (en) 2007-11-15
US20190241528A1 (en) 2019-08-08
HK1070369A1 (en) 2005-06-17
ATE520674T1 (en) 2011-09-15
EP1485360A4 (en) 2006-07-05
US20090227530A1 (en) 2009-09-10
AU2009225374B2 (en) 2011-12-22
KR101008728B1 (en) 2011-01-18
AU2009225374A1 (en) 2009-11-05
KR101183274B1 (en) 2012-09-14
US20170267650A1 (en) 2017-09-21
US20040229884A1 (en) 2004-11-18
US20030199456A1 (en) 2003-10-23
CY1112906T1 (en) 2016-04-13
US20040198748A1 (en) 2004-10-07
US20150376146A1 (en) 2015-12-31
EP1485360B1 (en) 2011-08-17
JP2010059210A (en) 2010-03-18
US20130012692A1 (en) 2013-01-10
KR101225201B1 (en) 2013-01-22
KR20040091064A (en) 2004-10-27
US8846688B2 (en) 2014-09-30
US10167266B2 (en) 2019-01-01

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US10167266B2 (en) Sodium channel blockers
US7241766B2 (en) Methods of using phenolic guanidine sodium channel blockers
US7868010B2 (en) Capped pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers
US20050113390A1 (en) Sodium channel blockers
US20130060034A1 (en) Aliphatic pyrazinoylguanidine sodium channel blockers with beta agonist activity

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AS Assignment

Owner name: PARION SCIENCES, INC., NORTH CAROLINA

Free format text: CHANGE OF NAME;ASSIGNOR:CYFI, INC,;REEL/FRAME:023470/0141

Effective date: 20020909

Owner name: CFI, INC., NORTH CAROLINA

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:JOHNSON, MICHAEL R.;REEL/FRAME:023469/0932

Effective date: 20020314

AS Assignment

Owner name: CYFI, INC., NORTH CAROLINA

Free format text: CORRECTIVE TO CORRECT THE SPELLING OF ASSIGNEE'S NAME ON THE NOTICE OF RECORDATION PREVIOUSLY RECORDED ON REEL 023469 FRAME 0932. ASSIGNOR(S) HEREBY CONFIRMS THE CORRECT SPELLING OF THE ASSIGNEE'S NAME IS CYFI, INC;ASSIGNOR:JOHNSON, MICHAEL R.;REEL/FRAME:024907/0877

Effective date: 20020314

STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION